Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v3.1
 
   1/*
   2 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   3 *
   4 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   5 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   6 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   7 *
   8 * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
   9 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as
  10 * published by the Free Software Foundation.
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
 
  16#include <linux/kernel.h>
  17#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  18#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  19#include <linux/wireless.h>
  20#include <linux/device.h>
  21#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
 
 
  23#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  24
  25/**
  26 * DOC: Introduction
  27 *
  28 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  29 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  30 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  31 * drivers.
  32 */
  33
  34/**
  35 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  36 *
  37 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  38 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  39 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  40 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  41 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  42 * tasklet function.
  43 *
  44 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  45 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  46 */
  47
  48/**
  49 * DOC: Warning
  50 *
  51 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  52 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  53 */
  54
  55/**
  56 * DOC: Frame format
  57 *
  58 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  59 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  60 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  61 * hardware.
  62 *
  63 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  64 *
  65 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  66 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  67 *
  68 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  69 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  70 *
  71 * Finally, for received frames, the driver is able to indicate that it has
  72 * filled a radiotap header and put that in front of the frame; if it does
  73 * not do so then mac80211 may add this under certain circumstances.
  74 */
  75
  76/**
  77 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  78 *
  79 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  80 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  81 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  82 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  83 *
  84 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  85 * suspend.
  86 *
  87 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  88 *
  89 */
  90
  91/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  92 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
  93 *
  94 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 
  95 */
  96enum ieee80211_max_queues {
  97	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		4,
 
  98};
  99
 
 
 100/**
 101 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 102 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 103 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 104 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 105 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 106 */
 107enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 108	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 109	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 110	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 111	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 112};
 113
 114/**
 115 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 116 *
 117 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 118 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 119 *
 120 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 121 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 122 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 123 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 124 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 
 125 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 
 
 126 */
 127struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 128	u16 txop;
 129	u16 cw_min;
 130	u16 cw_max;
 131	u8 aifs;
 
 132	bool uapsd;
 
 
 133};
 134
 135struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 136	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 137	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 138	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 139	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 140};
 141
 142/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 143 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 144 *
 145 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
 146 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
 147 *
 148 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 149 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 150 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 151 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 152 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 153 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 154 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 155 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 156 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 157 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 158 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 159 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 160 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 161 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 162 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 163 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 164 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 165 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 166 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 167 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 168 */
 169enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 170	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 171	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 172	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 173	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 174	BSS_CHANGED_HT                  = 1<<4,
 175	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 176	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 177	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 178	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 179	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 180	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 181	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 182	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 183	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 184	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 185
 186	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 187};
 188
 189/*
 190 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 191 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 192 * filtering will be disabled.
 193 */
 194#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 195
 196/**
 197 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event - RSSI threshold event
 198 * An indicator for when RSSI goes below/above a certain threshold.
 199 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi crossed the high threshold set by the driver.
 200 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi crossed the low threshold set by the driver.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 201 */
 202enum ieee80211_rssi_event {
 203	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 204	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 205};
 206
 207/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 208 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 209 *
 210 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 211 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 212 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 213 * @assoc: association status
 214 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
 215 *	or not
 
 216 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 217 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 218 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble;
 219 *	if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the
 220 *	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE hardware flag
 221 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP);
 222 *	if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the
 223 *	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE hardware flag
 224 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 225 *	valid in station mode only while @assoc is true and if also
 226 *	requested by %IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD (cf. also hw conf
 227 *	@ps_dtim_period)
 228 * @timestamp: beacon timestamp
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 229 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 230 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 231 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 232 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 233 *	the current band.
 
 234 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 235 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 236 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 237 * @channel_type: Channel type for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 238 *	configured for HT40+ while this BSS only uses no-HT, for
 239 *	example.
 240 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode (like in &struct ieee80211_ht_info).
 241 *	This field is only valid when the channel type is one of the HT types.
 
 
 242 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 243 *	implies disabled
 
 
 
 
 
 
 244 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 245 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 246 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 247 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 248 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 249 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list.
 250 * @arp_filter_enabled: Enable ARP filtering - if enabled, the hardware may
 251 *	filter ARP queries based on the @arp_addr_list, if disabled, the
 252 *	hardware must not perform any ARP filtering. Note, that the filter will
 253 *	be enabled also in promiscuous mode.
 254 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 255 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 256 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 257 *	your driver/device needs to do.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 258 */
 259struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 260	const u8 *bssid;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 261	/* association related data */
 262	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
 
 263	u16 aid;
 264	/* erp related data */
 265	bool use_cts_prot;
 266	bool use_short_preamble;
 267	bool use_short_slot;
 268	bool enable_beacon;
 269	u8 dtim_period;
 270	u16 beacon_int;
 271	u16 assoc_capability;
 272	u64 timestamp;
 
 
 273	u32 basic_rates;
 274	int mcast_rate[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 
 275	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 276	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 277	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 278	enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type;
 
 
 
 279	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
 280	u8 arp_addr_cnt;
 281	bool arp_filter_enabled;
 282	bool qos;
 283	bool idle;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 284};
 285
 286/**
 287 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 288 *
 289 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 290 *
 291 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 292 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 293 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 294 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 295 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 296 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 297 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 298 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 299 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 300 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 301 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 302 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 303 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 304 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 305 *	station
 306 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 307 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 308 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 309 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 310 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 311 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 312 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 313 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 314 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 315 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 316 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 317 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 318 *	hardware queue.
 319 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 320 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 321 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 322 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 323 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 324 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 325 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 326 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 
 
 
 327 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 328 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 329 *	it can be sent out.
 330 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 331 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 332 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 333 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 334 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE: (internal?)
 335 *	This frame is a response to a PS-poll frame and should be sent
 336 *	although the station is in powersave mode.
 337 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 338 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 339 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 340 *	queue gets full.
 341 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 342 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 343 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 344 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_HAS_RADIOTAP: This frame was injected and still
 345 *	has a radiotap header at skb->data.
 
 346 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 347 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 348 *	status to user space)
 349 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 350 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 351 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 352 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 353 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 354 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 355 *	handled properly by the device.
 356 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 357 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 358 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 359 *
 360 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 361 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 362 */
 363enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 364	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 365	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 366	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 367	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 368	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 369	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 370	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 371	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 372	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 373	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 374	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 375	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 376	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 
 377	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(14),
 378	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 379	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 380	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE	= BIT(17),
 381	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 382	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 383	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_HAS_RADIOTAP		= BIT(20),
 384	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 385	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 386	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 387	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 388	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 
 
 
 
 
 389};
 390
 391#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 392
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 393/*
 394 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 395 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 396 */
 397#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 398	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 399	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 400	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 401	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 402	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE | \
 403	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 404	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC)
 405
 406/**
 407 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 408 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 409 *
 410 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 411 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 412 *
 413 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 414 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 415 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 416 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 417 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 
 
 418 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 419 *	Greenfield mode.
 420 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 
 
 
 421 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 422 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 423 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 424 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 425 */
 426enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 427	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 428	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 429	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 430
 431	/* rate index is an MCS rate number instead of an index */
 432	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 433	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 434	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 435	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 436	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 
 
 
 437};
 438
 439
 440/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 441#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 442
 443/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 444#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 445
 446/* maximum number of rate stages */
 447#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	5
 
 
 
 448
 449/**
 450 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 451 *
 452 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 453 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 454 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 455 *
 456 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 457 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 458 *
 459 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 460 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 461 *
 462 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 463 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 464 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 465 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 466 * information
 
 467 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 
 468 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 469 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 470 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 471 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 472 * information should then contain
 
 473 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 
 474 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 475 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 476 */
 477struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
 478	s8 idx;
 479	u8 count;
 480	u8 flags;
 481} __packed;
 482
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 483/**
 484 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 485 *
 486 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 487 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 488 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 489 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 490 *
 491 * The TX control's sta pointer is only valid during the ->tx call,
 492 * it may be NULL.
 493 *
 494 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 495 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
 496 * @antenna_sel_tx: antenna to use, 0 for automatic diversity
 497 * @pad: padding, ignore
 498 * @control: union for control data
 499 * @status: union for status data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 500 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 501 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
 502 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 503 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
 504 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 505 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
 506 */
 507struct ieee80211_tx_info {
 508	/* common information */
 509	u32 flags;
 510	u8 band;
 511
 512	u8 antenna_sel_tx;
 513
 514	/* 2 byte hole */
 515	u8 pad[2];
 516
 517	union {
 518		struct {
 519			union {
 520				/* rate control */
 521				struct {
 522					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
 523						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 524					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
 
 
 
 
 
 525				};
 526				/* only needed before rate control */
 527				unsigned long jiffies;
 528			};
 529			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
 530			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 531			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
 532			struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 
 533		} control;
 534		struct {
 
 
 
 535			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 
 536			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
 537			int ack_signal;
 538			u8 ampdu_len;
 539			/* 15 bytes free */
 
 
 
 540		} status;
 541		struct {
 542			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
 543				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 
 
 544			void *rate_driver_data[
 545				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 546		};
 547		void *driver_data[
 548			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 549	};
 550};
 551
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 552/**
 553 * struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies - scheduled scan IEs
 554 *
 555 * This structure is used to pass the appropriate IEs to be used in scheduled
 556 * scans for all bands.  It contains both the IEs passed from the userspace
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 557 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
 558 *
 559 * @ie: array with the IEs for each supported band
 560 * @len: array with the total length of the IEs for each band
 561 */
 562struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies {
 563	u8 *ie[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 564	size_t len[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 
 
 
 
 565};
 566
 
 567static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 568{
 569	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
 570}
 571
 572static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 573{
 574	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
 575}
 576
 577/**
 578 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
 579 *
 580 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
 581 *
 582 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
 583 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
 584 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
 585 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
 586 *
 587 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
 588 *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
 589 *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
 590 */
 591static inline void
 592ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
 593{
 594	int i;
 595
 596	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
 597		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
 598	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
 599		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
 600	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
 601	/* clear the rate counts */
 602	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
 603		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
 604
 605	BUILD_BUG_ON(
 606	    offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len) != 23);
 607	memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
 608	       sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
 609	       offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
 610}
 611
 612
 613/**
 614 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
 615 *
 616 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
 617 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
 618 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
 619 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
 620 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
 621 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
 622 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV/ICV are stripped from this frame.
 623 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
 624 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 625 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
 626 *	the frame.
 627 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
 628 *	the frame.
 629 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_MPDU: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 630 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
 631 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
 632 *	merging.
 633 * @RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
 634 * @RX_FLAG_HT: HT MCS was used and rate_idx is MCS index
 635 * @RX_FLAG_40MHZ: HT40 (40 MHz) was used
 636 * @RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 637 */
 638enum mac80211_rx_flags {
 639	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR	= 1<<0,
 640	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED	= 1<<1,
 641	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED	= 1<<3,
 642	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED	= 1<<4,
 643	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC	= 1<<5,
 644	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = 1<<6,
 645	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_MPDU	= 1<<7,
 646	RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE	= 1<<8,
 647	RX_FLAG_HT		= 1<<9,
 648	RX_FLAG_40MHZ		= 1<<10,
 649	RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI	= 1<<11,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 650};
 651
 652/**
 653 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
 654 *
 655 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
 656 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
 657 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
 658 *
 659 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
 660 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
 
 
 
 
 661 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
 662 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
 
 
 
 663 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
 664 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
 665 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
 
 
 
 
 666 * @antenna: antenna used
 667 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
 668 *	HT rates are use (RX_FLAG_HT)
 669 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_*
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 670 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
 
 
 
 
 671 */
 672struct ieee80211_rx_status {
 673	u64 mactime;
 674	enum ieee80211_band band;
 675	int freq;
 676	int signal;
 677	int antenna;
 678	int rate_idx;
 679	int flag;
 680	unsigned int rx_flags;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 681};
 682
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 683/**
 684 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
 685 *
 686 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
 687 *
 688 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
 689 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
 690 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
 691 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
 692 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
 693 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
 694 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
 695 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
 696 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
 697 *	for more.
 698 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
 699 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
 700 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
 701 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
 702 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
 703 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
 704 *	operating channel.
 705 */
 706enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
 707	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
 708	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
 709	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
 710	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
 711};
 712
 713
 714/**
 715 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
 716 *
 717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
 718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
 719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
 720 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
 721 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
 722 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
 723 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
 724 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
 
 
 725 */
 726enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
 727	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
 728	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
 729	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
 730	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
 731	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
 732	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
 733	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
 734	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
 735};
 736
 737/**
 738 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
 739 *
 740 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
 741 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
 742 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
 743 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
 744 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
 745 */
 746enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
 747	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
 748	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
 749	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
 750	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
 751
 752	/* keep last */
 753	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
 754};
 755
 756/**
 757 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
 758 *
 759 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
 760 *
 761 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
 762 *
 763 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
 764 * @max_sleep_period: the maximum number of beacon intervals to sleep for
 765 *	before checking the beacon for a TIM bit (managed mode only); this
 766 *	value will be only achievable between DTIM frames, the hardware
 767 *	needs to check for the multicast traffic bit in DTIM beacons.
 768 *	This variable is valid only when the CONF_PS flag is set.
 769 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
 770 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
 771 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
 772 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
 773 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
 774 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
 775 *
 776 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm)
 
 777 *
 778 * @channel: the channel to tune to
 779 * @channel_type: the channel (HT) type
 780 *
 781 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
 782 *    (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
 783 *    but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
 784 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
 785 *    frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
 786 *    number of transmissions not the number of retries
 787 *
 788 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
 789 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
 790 *	configured for an HT channel
 
 
 791 */
 792struct ieee80211_conf {
 793	u32 flags;
 794	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
 795	int max_sleep_period;
 796
 797	u16 listen_interval;
 798	u8 ps_dtim_period;
 799
 800	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
 801
 802	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 803	enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type;
 804	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
 805};
 806
 807/**
 808 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
 809 *
 810 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
 811 * operation.
 812 *
 813 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
 814 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
 815 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
 816 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
 
 
 817 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
 818 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
 819 * @channel: the new channel to switch to
 820 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
 
 
 
 821 */
 822struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
 823	u64 timestamp;
 
 824	bool block_tx;
 825	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 826	u8 count;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 827};
 828
 829/**
 830 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
 831 *
 832 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
 833 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
 834 *
 835 * @type: type of this virtual interface
 836 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
 837 *	or the BSS we're associated to
 838 * @addr: address of this interface
 839 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
 840 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 841 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 842 *	sizeof(void *).
 
 
 
 843 */
 844struct ieee80211_vif {
 845	enum nl80211_iftype type;
 846	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
 847	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
 848	bool p2p;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 849	/* must be last */
 850	u8 drv_priv[0] __attribute__((__aligned__(sizeof(void *))));
 851};
 852
 853static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
 854{
 855#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
 856	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
 857#endif
 858	return false;
 859}
 860
 861/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 862 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
 863 *
 864 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
 865 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
 866 *
 867 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_WMM_STA: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
 868 *	that the STA this key will be used with could be using QoS.
 869 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
 870 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
 871 *	particular key.
 
 872 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
 873 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
 874 *	generation in software.
 875 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
 876 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
 877 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT: This flag should be set by the driver for a
 878 *	CCMP key if it requires CCMP encryption of management frames (MFP) to
 879 *	be done in software.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 880 */
 881enum ieee80211_key_flags {
 882	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_WMM_STA	= 1<<0,
 883	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV	= 1<<1,
 884	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC= 1<<2,
 885	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE	= 1<<3,
 886	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT	= 1<<4,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 887};
 888
 889/**
 890 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
 891 *
 892 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
 893 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
 894 *
 895 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
 896 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
 897 *	encrypted in hardware.
 898 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
 
 
 899 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
 900 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
 901 * @keylen: key material length
 902 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
 903 * 	data block:
 904 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
 905 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
 906 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
 907 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
 908 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
 909 */
 910struct ieee80211_key_conf {
 
 911	u32 cipher;
 912	u8 icv_len;
 913	u8 iv_len;
 914	u8 hw_key_idx;
 915	u8 flags;
 916	s8 keyidx;
 
 917	u8 keylen;
 918	u8 key[0];
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 919};
 920
 921/**
 922 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
 923 *
 924 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 925 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
 926 *
 927 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
 928 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
 929 */
 930enum set_key_cmd {
 931	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
 932};
 933
 934/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 935 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
 936 *
 937 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
 938 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
 939 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
 940 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
 941 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
 942 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
 943 *
 944 * @addr: MAC address
 945 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
 946 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
 947 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own TX capabilities
 948 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports WME. Only valid during AP-mode.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 949 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 950 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 951 */
 952struct ieee80211_sta {
 953	u32 supp_rates[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 954	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
 955	u16 aid;
 956	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
 
 
 
 
 957	bool wme;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 958
 959	/* must be last */
 960	u8 drv_priv[0] __attribute__((__aligned__(sizeof(void *))));
 961};
 962
 963/**
 964 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
 965 *
 966 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 967 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
 968 *
 969 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
 970 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
 971 */
 972enum sta_notify_cmd {
 973	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
 974};
 975
 976/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 977 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
 978 *
 979 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
 980 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
 981 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
 982 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
 983 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
 984 *
 985 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
 986 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
 987 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
 988 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
 989 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
 990 *	algorithm.
 991 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
 992 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
 993 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
 994 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
 995 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
 996 *	CCK frames.
 997 *
 998 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
 999 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
1000 *	the FCS at the end.
1001 *
1002 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
1003 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
1004 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
1005 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
1006 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
1007 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
1008 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
1009 *
1010 * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE:
1011 *	Hardware is not capable of short slot operation on the 2.4 GHz band.
1012 *
1013 * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE:
1014 *	Hardware is not capable of receiving frames with short preamble on
1015 *	the 2.4 GHz band.
1016 *
1017 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
1018 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
1019 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
1020 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
1021 *
1022 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
1023 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
1024 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
1025 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
1026 *
1027 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
1028 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
1029 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
1030 *
1031 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
1032 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
1033 *
1034 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
1035 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
1036 *
1037 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
1038 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
1039 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
1040 *
1041 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
1042 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
1043 *
1044 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
1045 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
1046 *
1047 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER:
1048 *	Hardware supports dropping of irrelevant beacon frames to
1049 *	avoid waking up cpu.
1050 *
1051 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS:
1052 *	Hardware supports static spatial multiplexing powersave,
1053 *	ie. can turn off all but one chain even on HT connections
1054 *	that should be using more chains.
1055 *
1056 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS:
1057 *	Hardware supports dynamic spatial multiplexing powersave,
1058 *	ie. can turn off all but one chain and then wake the rest
1059 *	up as required after, for example, rts/cts handshake.
1060 *
1061 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD:
1062 *	Hardware supports Unscheduled Automatic Power Save Delivery
1063 *	(U-APSD) in managed mode. The mode is configured with
1064 *	conf_tx() operation.
1065 *
1066 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
1067 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
1068 *	the stack.
1069 *
1070 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
1071 *      The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
1072 *      periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
1073 *      When this flag is set, signaling beacon-loss will cause an immediate
1074 *      change to disassociated state.
1075 *
1076 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI:
1077 *	Hardware can do connection quality monitoring - i.e. it can monitor
1078 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1079 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1080 *
1081 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD:
1082 *	This device needs to know the DTIM period for the BSS before
1083 *	associating.
1084 *
1085 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
1086 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
1087 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
1088 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
1089 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
1090 *	only in that case.
1091 *
1092 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
1093 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
1094 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
1095 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
1096 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
1097 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1098 */
1099enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
1100	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL			= 1<<0,
1101	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS			= 1<<1,
1102	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING	= 1<<2,
1103	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE		= 1<<3,
1104	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE	= 1<<4,
1105	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC			= 1<<5,
1106	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM				= 1<<6,
1107	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD			= 1<<7,
1108	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT			= 1<<8,
1109	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION			= 1<<9,
1110	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS			= 1<<10,
1111	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK			= 1<<11,
1112	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS		= 1<<12,
1113	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE			= 1<<13,
1114	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER			= 1<<14,
1115	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS		= 1<<15,
1116	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS		= 1<<16,
1117	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD			= 1<<17,
1118	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS		= 1<<18,
1119	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR			= 1<<19,
1120	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI			= 1<<20,
1121	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK		= 1<<21,
1122	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS				= 1<<22,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1123};
1124
1125/**
1126 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
1127 *
1128 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
1129 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
1130 *
1131 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
1132 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
1133 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
1134 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
1135 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
1136 *
1137 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
1138 *
1139 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
1140 *	along with this structure.
1141 *
1142 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
1143 *
1144 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
1145 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
1146 *
1147 * @channel_change_time: time (in microseconds) it takes to change channels.
 
1148 *
1149 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
1150 *     only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
1151 *
1152 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
1153 *     that HW supports
1154 *
1155 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
1156 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
1157 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
1158 *
1159 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
1160 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
1161 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
1162 *
1163 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
1164 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
1165 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
1166 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
 
 
 
 
1167 *
1168 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
1169 *	can handle.
1170 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
1171 *	the hw can report back.
1172 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
1173 *
1174 * @napi_weight: weight used for NAPI polling.  You must specify an
1175 *	appropriate value here if a napi_poll operation is provided
1176 *	by your driver.
1177 *
1178 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
1179 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
1180 *	aggregation.
1181 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
1182 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
1183 *	it shouldn't be set.
1184 *
1185 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
1186 *	aggregate an HT driver will transmit, used by the peer as a
1187 *	hint to size its reorder buffer.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1188 */
1189struct ieee80211_hw {
1190	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
1191	struct wiphy *wiphy;
1192	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
1193	void *priv;
1194	u32 flags;
1195	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
1196	int channel_change_time;
1197	int vif_data_size;
1198	int sta_data_size;
1199	int napi_weight;
 
1200	u16 queues;
1201	u16 max_listen_interval;
1202	s8 max_signal;
1203	u8 max_rates;
1204	u8 max_report_rates;
1205	u8 max_rate_tries;
1206	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
1207	u8 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1208};
1209
1210/**
1211 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
1212 *
1213 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
1214 *
1215 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
1216 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
1217 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
1218 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
1219 * is already used internally by mac80211.
 
 
1220 */
1221struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
1222
1223/**
1224 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
1225 *
1226 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
1227 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
1228 */
1229static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
1230{
1231	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
1232}
1233
1234/**
1235 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
1236 *
1237 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
1238 * @addr: the address to set
1239 */
1240static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 *addr)
1241{
1242	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
1243}
1244
1245static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1246ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1247		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
1248{
1249	if (WARN_ON(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
1250		return NULL;
1251	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
1252}
1253
1254static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1255ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1256			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
1257{
1258	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
1259		return NULL;
1260	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
1261}
1262
1263static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1264ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1265			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
1266{
1267	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
1268		return NULL;
1269	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
1270}
1271
1272/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1273 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
1274 *
1275 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
1276 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
1277 *
1278 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
1279 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
1280 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
1281 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
1282 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
1283 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
1284 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
1285 *
1286 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
1287 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
1288 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
1289 *
1290 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
1291 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
1292 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
1293 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
1294 *
 
 
 
 
 
1295 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
1296 *
1297 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
1298 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
1299 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
1300 * based on the receive flags.
1301 *
1302 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
1303 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
1304 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
1305 * keys.
1306 *
1307 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
1308 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
1309 * handler.
1310 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
1311 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
1312 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
1313 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
1314 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
1315 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1316 */
1317
1318/**
1319 * DOC: Powersave support
1320 *
1321 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
1322 *
1323 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
1324 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
1325 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
1326 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
1327 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
1328 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
1329 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
1330 * it finds traffic directed to it.
1331 *
1332 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
1333 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
1334 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
1335 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
1336 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
1337 *
1338 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
1339 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
1340 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
1341 *
1342 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
1343 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
1344 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
1345 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
1346 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
1347 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
1348 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
1349 *
1350 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
1351 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
1352 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
1353 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
1354 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
1355 * periods.
1356 *
1357 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
1358 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
1359 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
1360 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
1361 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
1362 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
1363 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
1364 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
1365 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
1366 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
1367 *
1368 * Some hardware need to toggle a single shared antenna between WLAN and
1369 * Bluetooth to facilitate co-existence. These types of hardware set
1370 * limitations on the use of host controlled dynamic powersave whenever there
1371 * is simultaneous WLAN and Bluetooth traffic. For these types of hardware, the
1372 * driver may request temporarily going into full power save, in order to
1373 * enable toggling the antenna between BT and WLAN. If the driver requests
1374 * disabling dynamic powersave, the @dynamic_ps_timeout value will be
1375 * temporarily set to zero until the driver re-enables dynamic powersave.
1376 *
1377 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
1378 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
1379 * uapsd paramater in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
1380 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
1381 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
1382 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
1383 *
1384 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
1385 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
1386 */
1387
1388/**
1389 * DOC: Beacon filter support
1390 *
1391 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
1392 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usuallly works so that
1393 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
1394 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
1395 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
1396 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
1397 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
1398 *
1399 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER
1400 * hardware capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
1401 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
1402 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
1403 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
1404 *
1405 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
1406 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
1407 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
1408 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
1409 *
1410 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
1411 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
1412 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
1413 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
 
1414 *  - a list of information element IDs
1415 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
1416 *
1417 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
1418 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
1419 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
1420 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
1421 * vendor information elements.
1422 *
1423 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
1424 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
1425 *
1426 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
1427 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
1428 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
1429 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
1430 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
1431 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
1432 *
1433 *
1434 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
1435 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
1436 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
1437 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
1438 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
1439 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
1440 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
1441 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
1442 *
1443 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
1444 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
1445 * signal strength threshold checking.
1446 */
1447
1448/**
1449 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
1450 *
1451 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
1452 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
1453 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
1454 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
1455 *
1456 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
1457 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
1458 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
1459 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
1460 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
1461 * hardware flags.
1462 *
1463 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
1464 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
1465 * turned off otherwise.
1466 *
1467 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
1468 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
1469 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
1470 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
1471 */
1472
1473/**
1474 * DOC: Frame filtering
1475 *
1476 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
1477 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
1478 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
1479 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
1480 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
1481 *
1482 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
1483 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
1484 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
1485 *
1486 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
1487 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
1488 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
1489 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
1490 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
1491 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
1492 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
1493 *
1494 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
1495 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
1496 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
1497 * or dropped.
1498 *
1499 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
1500 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
1501 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
1502 * the flag, but not clear it.
1503 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
1504 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
1505 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
1506 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
1507 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
1508 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
1509 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
1510 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
1511 */
1512
1513/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1514 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
1515 *
1516 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
1517 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
1518 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
1519 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
1520 *
1521 * @FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS: promiscuous mode within your BSS,
1522 *	think of the BSS as your network segment and then this corresponds
1523 *	to the regular ethernet device promiscuous mode.
1524 *
1525 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
1526 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
1527 *	multicast address.
1528 *
1529 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
1530 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
1531 *
1532 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
1533 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
1534 *
1535 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
1536 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
1537 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
1538 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
1539 *	honour this flag if possible.
1540 *
1541 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll), if PROMISC_IN_BSS
1542 * 	is not set then only those addressed to this station.
1543 *
1544 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
1545 *
1546 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames, if PROMISC_IN_BSS is not set then only
1547 * 	those addressed to this station.
1548 *
1549 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
 
 
1550 */
1551enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
1552	FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS	= 1<<0,
1553	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
1554	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
1555	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
1556	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
1557	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
1558	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
1559	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
1560	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
 
1561};
1562
1563/**
1564 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
1565 *
1566 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
1567 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
1568 *
1569 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
1570 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
1571 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
1572 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
1573 *
1574 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start Rx aggregation
1575 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop Rx aggregation
1576 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start Tx aggregation
1577 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP: stop Tx aggregation
 
 
 
 
1578 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1579 */
1580enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
1581	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
1582	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
1583	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
1584	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP,
 
 
1585	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
1586};
1587
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1588/**
1589 * enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type - TX sync type
1590 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_AUTH: sync TX for authentication
1591 *	(and possibly also before direct probe)
1592 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ASSOC: sync TX for association
1593 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ACTION: sync TX for action frame
1594 *	(not implemented yet)
1595 */
1596enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type {
1597	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_AUTH,
1598	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ASSOC,
1599	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ACTION,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1600};
1601
1602/**
1603 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
1604 *
1605 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
1606 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
1607 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
1608 *
1609 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
1610 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
1611 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
1612 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
1613 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately, more
1614 *	importantly, however, it must never fail for A-MPDU-queues.
1615 *	This function should return NETDEV_TX_OK except in very
1616 *	limited cases.
1617 *	Must be implemented and atomic.
1618 *
1619 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
1620 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
1621 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
1622 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
1623 *	or zero.
1624 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
1625 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
1626 *	is added.
1627 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1628 *
1629 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
1630 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
1631 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
1632 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
1633 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
1634 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
1635 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1636 *
1637 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
1638 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
1639 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
1640 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
1641 *	reconfigured at resume time.
1642 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
1643 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
1644 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
1645 *	must return 1 from this function.
1646 *
1647 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
1648 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
1649 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
1650 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
1651 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
1652 *
 
 
 
 
 
1653 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
1654 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
1655 *	and @stop must be implemented.
1656 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
1657 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
1658 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
1659 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
1660 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
1661 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1662 *
1663 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
1664 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
1665 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
1666 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
1667 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
1668 *
1669 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
1670 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
1671 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
1672 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
1673 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
1674 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
1675 *	MAC address of the device going away.
1676 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
1677 *
1678 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
1679 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
1680 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
1681 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
1682 *
1683 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
1684 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
1685 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
1686 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
1687 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
1688 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
1689 *	can sleep.
1690 *
1691 * @tx_sync: Called before a frame is sent to an AP/GO. In the GO case, the
1692 *	driver should sync with the GO's powersaving so the device doesn't
1693 *	transmit the frame while the GO is asleep. In the regular AP case
1694 *	it may be used by drivers for devices implementing other restrictions
1695 *	on talking to APs, e.g. due to regulatory enforcement or just HW
1696 *	restrictions.
1697 *	This function is called for every authentication, association and
1698 *	action frame separately since applications might attempt to auth
1699 *	with multiple APs before chosing one to associate to. If it returns
1700 *	an error, the corresponding authentication, association or frame
1701 *	transmission is aborted and reported as having failed. It is always
1702 *	called after tuning to the correct channel.
1703 *	The callback might be called multiple times before @finish_tx_sync
1704 *	(but @finish_tx_sync will be called once for each) but in practice
1705 *	this is unlikely to happen. It can also refuse in that case if the
1706 *	driver cannot handle that situation.
1707 *	This callback can sleep.
1708 * @finish_tx_sync: Called as a counterpart to @tx_sync, unless that returned
1709 *	an error. This callback can sleep.
1710 *
1711 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
1712 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
1713 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
1714 *
1715 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
1716 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
1717 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
1718 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1719 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
1720 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
1721 *
1722 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
1723 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
1724 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
1725 *	is enabled.
1726 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
1727 *	The callback can sleep.
1728 *
1729 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
1730 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
1731 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
1732 *	The callback must be atomic.
1733 *
1734 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
1735 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
1736 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
1737 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
1738 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
1739 *
 
 
 
 
1740 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
1741 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
1742 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
1743 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
1744 *	that power save is disabled.
1745 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
1746 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
1747 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
1748 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
1749 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
1750 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
1751 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
 
 
 
 
 
1752 *	The callback can sleep.
1753 *
1754 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
1755 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
1756 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
1757 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
1758 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
1759 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
1760 *	The callback can sleep.
1761 *
1762 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
1763 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
1764 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
1765 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
1766 *
1767 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
 
1768 *
1769 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
1770 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
1771 *	The callback can sleep.
 
 
1772 *
1773 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
1774 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
1775 *	this notification.
1776 *	The callback can sleep.
1777 *
1778 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
1779 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
1780 *	The callback can sleep.
1781 *
1782 * @get_tkip_seq: If your device implements TKIP encryption in hardware this
1783 *	callback should be provided to read the TKIP transmit IVs (both IV32
1784 *	and IV16) for the given key from hardware.
1785 *	The callback must be atomic.
1786 *
1787 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
1788 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself; if this callback is
1789 *	implemented then the stack will not do fragmentation.
 
1790 *	The callback can sleep.
1791 *
1792 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
1793 *	The callback can sleep.
1794 *
1795 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
1796 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
1797 *
1798 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
1799 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1800 *
1801 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
1802 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
1803 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
1804 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
1805 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1806 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
1807 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
1808 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
1809 *	The callback can sleep.
1810 *
1811 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
1812 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
1813 *	required function.
1814 *	The callback can sleep.
1815 *
1816 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
1817 *      Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
1818 *	required function.
1819 *	The callback can sleep.
1820 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
1821 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
1822 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
1823 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
1824 *	TSF synchronization.
1825 *	The callback can sleep.
1826 *
1827 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
1828 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
1829 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
1830 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
1831 *	The callback can sleep.
1832 *
1833 * @ampdu_action: Perform a certain A-MPDU action
1834 * 	The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
1835 * 	the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
1836 * 	ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. Starting sequence number (@ssn)
1837 * 	is the first frame we expect to perform the action on. Notice
1838 * 	that TX/RX_STOP can pass NULL for this parameter.
1839 *	The @buf_size parameter is only valid when the action is set to
1840 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL and indicates the peer's reorder
1841 *	buffer size (number of subframes) for this session -- the driver
1842 *	may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than this
1843 *	nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
1844 *	buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
1845 *	possible with a buf_size of 8:
1846 *	 - TX: 1.....7
1847 *	 - RX:  2....7 (lost frame #1)
1848 *	 - TX:        8..1...
1849 *	which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
1850 *	buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
1851 *	 - TX:       1 or 18 or 81
1852 *	Even "189" would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
1853 *
1854 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
1855 *	The callback can sleep.
1856 *
1857 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
1858 *
1859 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
1860 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
1861 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
1862 *	The callback can sleep.
1863 *
1864 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
1865 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
1866 *	accordingly. This callback is not required and may sleep.
 
 
1867 *
1868 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command.
1869 *	The callback can sleep.
1870 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
1871 *
1872 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
1873 *	that the hardware queues are empty. If the parameter @drop is set
1874 *	to %true, pending frames may be dropped. The callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
1875 *
1876 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
1877 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
1878 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
1879 *	completion of the channel switch.
1880 *
1881 * @napi_poll: Poll Rx queue for incoming data frames.
1882 *
1883 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
1884 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
1885 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
1886 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
1887 *
1888 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
1889 *
1890 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
1891 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
1892 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
1893 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
1894 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
1895 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
1896 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). This callback may sleep.
 
 
 
1897 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
1898 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
1899 * @offchannel_tx: Transmit frame on another channel, wait for a response
1900 *	and return. Reliable TX status must be reported for the frame. If the
1901 *	return value is 1, then the @remain_on_channel will be used with a
1902 *	regular transmission (if supported.)
1903 * @offchannel_tx_cancel_wait: cancel wait associated with offchannel TX
1904 *
1905 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
1906 *
1907 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
1908 *
1909 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
1910 *	queues before entering power save.
1911 *
1912 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
1913 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
1914 *	The callback can sleep.
1915 * @rssi_callback: Notify driver when the average RSSI goes above/below
1916 *	thresholds that were registered previously. The callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1917 */
1918struct ieee80211_ops {
1919	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
 
 
1920	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1921	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1922#ifdef CONFIG_PM
1923	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
1924	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
1925#endif
1926	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1927			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1928	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1929				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1930				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
1931	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1932				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1933	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
1934	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1935				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1936				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
1937				 u32 changed);
1938
1939	int (*tx_sync)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1940		       const u8 *bssid, enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type type);
1941	void (*finish_tx_sync)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1942			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1943			       const u8 *bssid,
1944			       enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type type);
1945
1946	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1947				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
1948	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1949				 unsigned int changed_flags,
1950				 unsigned int *total_flags,
1951				 u64 multicast);
 
 
 
 
1952	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1953		       bool set);
1954	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
1955		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1956		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
1957	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1958				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1959				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
1960				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1961				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
1962	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1963			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1964			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
 
 
1965	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1966		       struct cfg80211_scan_request *req);
1967	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1968			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1969	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1970				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1971				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
1972				struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies *ies);
1973	void (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1974			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1975	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1976	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
1977	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1978			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
1979	void (*get_tkip_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 hw_key_idx,
1980			     u32 *iv32, u16 *iv16);
 
1981	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
1982	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
1983	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1984		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
1985	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1986			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
 
 
 
 
 
 
1987	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1988			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
1989	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u16 queue,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1990		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
1991	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1992	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u64 tsf);
1993	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
1994	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1995	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1996			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1997			    enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action,
1998			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, u16 *ssn,
1999			    u8 buf_size);
2000	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
2001		struct survey_info *survey);
2002	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2003	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 coverage_class);
2004#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
2005	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *data, int len);
 
2006	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
2007			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
2008			     void *data, int len);
2009#endif
2010	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool drop);
 
2011	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2012			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
2013	int (*napi_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int budget);
2014	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
2015	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
2016
2017	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2018				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
2019				 enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type,
2020				 int duration);
2021	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2022	int (*offchannel_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
2023			     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
2024			     enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type,
2025			     unsigned int wait);
2026	int (*offchannel_tx_cancel_wait)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2027	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
2028	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2029			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
2030	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2031	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2032				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
2033	void (*rssi_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2034			      enum ieee80211_rssi_event rssi_event);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2035};
2036
2037/**
2038 * ieee80211_alloc_hw -  Allocate a new hardware device
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2039 *
2040 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
2041 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
2042 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
2043 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
2044 * @priv_data_len.
2045 *
2046 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
2047 * @ops: callbacks for this device
 
 
2048 */
 
2049struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
2050					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops);
 
 
 
2051
2052/**
2053 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
2054 *
2055 * You must call this function before any other functions in
2056 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
2057 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
2058 *
2059 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 
 
2060 */
2061int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2062
2063/**
2064 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
2065 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
2066 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
2067 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
2068 */
2069struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
2070	int throughput;
2071	int blink_time;
2072};
2073
2074/**
2075 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
2076 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
2077 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
2078 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
2079 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
2080 */
2081enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
2082	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
2083	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
2084	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
2085};
2086
2087#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2088extern char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2089extern char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2090extern char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2091extern char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2092extern char *__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(
2093				struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
2094				const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
2095				unsigned int blink_table_len);
 
2096#endif
2097/**
2098 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
2099 *
2100 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2101 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2102 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2103 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2104 *
2105 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2106 */
2107static inline char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2108{
2109#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2110	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
2111#else
2112	return NULL;
2113#endif
2114}
2115
2116/**
2117 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
2118 *
2119 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2120 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2121 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2122 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2123 *
2124 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2125 */
2126static inline char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2127{
2128#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2129	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
2130#else
2131	return NULL;
2132#endif
2133}
2134
2135/**
2136 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
2137 *
2138 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2139 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2140 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2141 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2142 *
2143 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2144 */
2145static inline char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2146{
2147#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2148	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
2149#else
2150	return NULL;
2151#endif
2152}
2153
2154/**
2155 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
2156 *
2157 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2158 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2159 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2160 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2161 *
2162 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2163 */
2164static inline char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2165{
2166#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2167	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
2168#else
2169	return NULL;
2170#endif
2171}
2172
2173/**
2174 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
2175 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
2176 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
2177 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
2178 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
2179 *
2180 * This function returns %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED
2181 * triggers are configured) or the name of the new trigger.
2182 * This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
 
2183 */
2184static inline char *
2185ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
2186				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
2187				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
2188{
2189#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2190	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
2191						  blink_table_len);
2192#else
2193	return NULL;
2194#endif
2195}
2196
2197/**
2198 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
2199 *
2200 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
2201 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
2202 *
2203 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
2204 */
2205void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2206
2207/**
2208 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
2209 *
2210 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
2211 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
2212 * before calling this function.
2213 *
2214 * @hw: the hardware to free
2215 */
2216void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2217
2218/**
2219 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
2220 *
2221 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
2222 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
2223 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
2224 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
2225 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
2226 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
2227 *
2228 * @hw: the hardware to restart
2229 */
2230void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2231
2232/** ieee80211_napi_schedule - schedule NAPI poll
 
2233 *
2234 * Use this function to schedule NAPI polling on a device.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2235 *
2236 * @hw: the hardware to start polling
 
 
 
 
 
2237 */
2238void ieee80211_napi_schedule(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
2239
2240/** ieee80211_napi_complete - complete NAPI polling
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2241 *
2242 * Use this function to finish NAPI polling on a device.
2243 *
2244 * @hw: the hardware to stop polling
 
 
 
2245 */
2246void ieee80211_napi_complete(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
2247
2248/**
2249 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
2250 *
2251 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
2252 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
2253 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
2254 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
2255 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
2256 *
2257 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
2258 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
2259 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
2260 * mixed for a single hardware.
 
2261 *
2262 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
2263 *
2264 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2265 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2266 */
2267void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
 
 
 
2268
2269/**
2270 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
2271 *
2272 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
2273 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
2274 *
2275 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
2276 * be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2277 *
2278 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2279 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2280 */
2281void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2282
2283/**
2284 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
2285 *
2286 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
2287 * (internally disables bottom halves).
2288 *
2289 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
2290 * not be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2291 *
2292 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2293 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2294 */
2295static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2296				   struct sk_buff *skb)
2297{
2298	local_bh_disable();
2299	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
2300	local_bh_enable();
2301}
2302
2303/**
2304 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
2305 *
2306 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
2307 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
2308 * entering/leaving PS mode.
2309 *
2310 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
2311 *
2312 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
2313 * each other.
2314 *
2315 * The function returns -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
2316 *
2317 * @sta: currently connected sta
2318 * @start: start or stop PS
 
 
2319 */
2320int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
2321
2322/**
2323 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
2324 *                                  (in process context)
2325 *
2326 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
2327 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
2328 * applies.
2329 *
2330 * @sta: currently connected sta
2331 * @start: start or stop PS
 
 
2332 */
2333static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
2334						  bool start)
2335{
2336	int ret;
2337
2338	local_bh_disable();
2339	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
2340	local_bh_enable();
2341
2342	return ret;
2343}
2344
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2345/*
2346 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
2347 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
2348 */
2349#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	13
2350
2351/**
2352 * ieee80211_sta_set_tim - set the TIM bit for a sleeping station
2353 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
 
 
2354 *
2355 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
2356 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station needs to be told
2357 * to wake up using the TIM bitmap in the beacon.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2358 *
2359 * This function sets the station's TIM bit - it will be cleared when the
2360 * station wakes up.
 
 
 
2361 */
2362void ieee80211_sta_set_tim(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2363
2364/**
2365 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
2366 *
2367 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
2368 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
2369 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
2370 *
2371 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
2372 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
2373 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
2374 * may not be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2375 *
2376 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2377 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2378 */
2379void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2380			 struct sk_buff *skb);
2381
2382/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2383 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
2384 *
2385 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
2386 *
2387 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
2388 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
2389 * for a single hardware.
2390 *
2391 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2392 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2393 */
2394static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2395					  struct sk_buff *skb)
2396{
2397	local_bh_disable();
2398	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
2399	local_bh_enable();
2400}
2401
2402/**
2403 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
2404 *
2405 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
2406 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
2407 *
2408 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
2409 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
2410 *
2411 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2412 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2413 */
2414void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2415				 struct sk_buff *skb);
2416
2417/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2418 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
2419 *
2420 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
2421 * connected STA.
2422 *
2423 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
2424 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
2425 */
2426void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
2427
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2428/**
2429 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
2430 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2431 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2432 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
2433 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
2434 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
2435 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
2436 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
2437 *
2438 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
2439 * obtain the beacon frame/template.
2440 *
2441 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2442 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
2443 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function
2444 * before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
2445 *
2446 * If the beacon frames are generated by the device, then the driver
2447 * must use the returned beacon as the template and change the TIM IE
2448 * according to the current DTIM parameters/TIM bitmap.
2449 *
2450 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 
 
2451 */
2452struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2453					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2454					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
2455
2456/**
2457 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
2458 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2459 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2460 *
2461 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
 
 
2462 */
2463static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2464						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2465{
2466	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
2467}
2468
2469/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2470 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
2471 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2472 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2473 *
2474 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
2475 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
2476 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
2477 *
2478 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
2479 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
 
 
2480 */
2481struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2482				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2483
2484/**
2485 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
2486 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2487 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
2488 *
2489 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
2490 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
2491 * BSSID and address is used.
2492 *
 
 
 
2493 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
2494 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
 
 
2495 */
2496struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2497				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
2498
2499/**
2500 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
2501 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2502 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2503 * @ssid: SSID buffer
2504 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
2505 * @ie: buffer containing all IEs except SSID for the template
2506 * @ie_len: length of the IE buffer
2507 *
2508 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
2509 * hardware.
 
 
2510 */
2511struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2512				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2513				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
2514				       const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len);
2515
2516/**
2517 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
2518 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2519 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2520 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
2521 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
2522 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2523 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
2524 *
2525 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2526 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2527 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
2528 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
2529 */
2530void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2531		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
2532		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
2533		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
2534
2535/**
2536 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
2537 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2538 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2539 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
2540 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2541 *
2542 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
2543 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2544 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 
 
2545 */
2546__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2547			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
2548			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
2549
2550/**
2551 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
2552 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2553 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2554 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
2555 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
2556 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2557 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
2558 *
2559 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2560 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2561 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
2562 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
2563 */
2564void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2565			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2566			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
2567			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
2568			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
2569
2570/**
2571 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
2572 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2573 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2574 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
2575 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2576 *
2577 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
2578 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2579 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 
 
2580 */
2581__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2582				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2583				    size_t frame_len,
2584				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
2585
2586/**
2587 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
2588 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2589 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
2590 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
2591 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
2592 *
2593 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
2594 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
 
 
2595 */
2596__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2597					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
 
2598					size_t frame_len,
2599					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
2600
2601/**
2602 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
2603 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2604 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2605 *
2606 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
2607 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
2608 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
2609 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
2610 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. This
2611 * function returns a pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more
2612 * buffered frames are available.
 
2613 *
2614 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
2615 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
2616 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
2617 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
2618 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
2619 * use common code for all beacons.
2620 */
2621struct sk_buff *
2622ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2623
2624/**
2625 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
2626 *
2627 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
2628 *
2629 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2630 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
2631 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2632 */
2633void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2634			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
2635
2636/**
2637 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
2638 *
2639 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
2640 * from the given packet.
2641 *
2642 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2643 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
2644 *	with this P1K
2645 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2646 */
2647static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2648					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
2649{
2650	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
2651	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
2652	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
2653
2654	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
2655}
2656
2657/**
2658 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
2659 *
2660 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
2661 * and transmitter address.
2662 *
2663 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2664 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
2665 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
2666 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2667 */
2668void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2669			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
2670
2671/**
2672 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
2673 *
2674 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
2675 * in the packet.
2676 *
2677 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2678 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
2679 *	encrypted with this key
2680 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
2681 */
2682void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2683			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
2684
2685/**
2686 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2687 *
2688 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2689 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2690 *	reverse order than in packet)
2691 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2692 *	reverse order than in packet)
2693 */
2694struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2695	union {
2696		struct {
2697			u32 iv32;
2698			u16 iv16;
2699		} tkip;
2700		struct {
2701			u8 pn[6];
2702		} ccmp;
2703		struct {
2704			u8 pn[6];
2705		} aes_cmac;
2706	};
2707};
2708
2709/**
2710 * ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq - get key TX sequence counter
2711 *
 
2712 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2713 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
 
 
 
2714 *
2715 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current TX IV/PN
2716 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV generation is
2717 * offloaded to the device.
2718 *
2719 * Note that this function may only be called when no TX processing
2720 * can be done concurrently, for example when queues are stopped
2721 * and the stop has been synchronized.
2722 */
2723void ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2724			      struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
2725
2726/**
2727 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
2728 *
2729 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2730 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP only);
2731 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
2732 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
2733 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
2734 *
2735 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
2736 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
2737 * by the device and not by mac80211.
2738 *
2739 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
2740 * can be done concurrently.
2741 */
2742void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2743			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
2744
2745/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2746 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
2747 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
2748 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
2749 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
2750 * @gfp: allocation flags
2751 */
2752void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
2753				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
2754
2755/**
2756 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
2757 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2758 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2759 *
2760 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
2761 */
2762void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2763
2764/**
2765 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
2766 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2767 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2768 *
2769 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
2770 */
2771void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2772
2773/**
2774 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
2775 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2776 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2777 *
2778 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
 
 
2779 */
2780
2781int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2782
2783/**
2784 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
2785 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2786 *
2787 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
2788 */
2789void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2790
2791/**
2792 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
2793 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2794 *
2795 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
2796 */
2797void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2798
2799/**
2800 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
2801 *
2802 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
2803 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
2804 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
2805 * any context, including hardirq context.
2806 *
2807 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
2808 * @aborted: set to true if scan was aborted
2809 */
2810void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool aborted);
 
2811
2812/**
2813 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
2814 *
2815 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
2816 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
2817 *
2818 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
2819 */
2820void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2821
2822/**
2823 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
2824 *
2825 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
2826 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
2827 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
2828 * while associating, for instance.
2829 *
2830 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
2831 */
2832void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2833
2834/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2835 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
2836 *
2837 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
2838 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
2839 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
2840 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
2841 * be used.
2842 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface()
2843 *
2844 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 
2845 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
2846 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
2847 */
2848void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2849					 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
2850						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
2851					 void *data);
 
 
 
 
 
 
2852
2853/**
2854 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
2855 *
2856 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
2857 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
2858 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
2859 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
2860 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface()
2861 *
2862 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 
2863 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
2864 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
2865 */
2866void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2867						void (*iterator)(void *data,
2868						    u8 *mac,
2869						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
2870						void *data);
2871
2872/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2873 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
2874 *
2875 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
2876 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
2877 *
2878 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
2879 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
2880 */
2881void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
2882
2883/**
2884 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
2885 *
2886 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
2887 * workqueue.
2888 *
2889 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
2890 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
2891 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
2892 */
2893void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2894				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
2895				  unsigned long delay);
2896
2897/**
2898 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
2899 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
2900 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
2901 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
2902 *
2903 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
2904 *
2905 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
2906 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
2907 * will be managed by the mac80211.
2908 */
2909int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
2910				  u16 timeout);
2911
2912/**
2913 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
2914 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
2915 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
2916 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
2917 *
2918 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
2919 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
2920 * from any context.
2921 */
2922void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
2923				      u16 tid);
2924
2925/**
2926 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
2927 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
2928 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
2929 *
2930 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
2931 *
2932 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
2933 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
2934 * will be managed by the mac80211.
2935 */
2936int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
2937
2938/**
2939 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
2940 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
2941 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
2942 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
2943 *
2944 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
2945 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
2946 * can be called from any context.
2947 */
2948void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
2949				     u16 tid);
2950
2951/**
2952 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
2953 *
2954 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
2955 * @addr: station's address
2956 *
2957 * This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 
 
2958 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
2959 */
2960struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2961					 const u8 *addr);
2962
2963/**
2964 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
2965 *
2966 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
2967 * @addr: remote station's address
2968 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
2969 *
2970 * This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 
 
2971 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
2972 *
2973 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
2974 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
2975 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
2976 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
2977 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
2978 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
2979 *      is not reliable.
2980 *
2981 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
2982 */
2983struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2984					       const u8 *addr,
2985					       const u8 *localaddr);
2986
2987/**
2988 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
2989 * @hw: the hardware
2990 * @pubsta: the station
2991 * @block: whether to block or unblock
2992 *
2993 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
2994 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
2995 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
2996 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
2997 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
2998 *
2999 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
3000 * manner.
3001 *
3002 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
3003 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
3004 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
3005 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
3006 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
3007 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
3008 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
3009 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
3010 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
3011 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
3012 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
3013 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
3014 * woke up while blocked or not.
3015 */
3016void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3017			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
3018
3019/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3020 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
3021 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3022 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
3023 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
3024 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
3025 *
3026 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
3027 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
3028 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
3029 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
3030 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
3031 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
3032 *
3033 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
3034 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
3035 * set_key callback.
3036 */
3037void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3038			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3039			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3040				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3041				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3042				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3043				      void *data),
3044			 void *iter_data);
3045
3046/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3047 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
3048 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
3049 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3050 *
3051 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
3052 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
3053 * information. This function must only be called from within the
3054 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
3055 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
3056 * NULL.
 
 
3057 */
3058struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3059					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3060
3061/**
3062 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
3063 *
3064 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3065 *
3066 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER and
3067 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
3068 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
3069 */
3070void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3071
3072/**
3073 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
3074 *
3075 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3076 *
3077 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER, and
3078 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
3079 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
 
 
3080 *
3081 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
3082 * without connection recovery attempts.
3083 */
3084void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3085
3086/**
3087 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
3088 *
3089 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3090 *
3091 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
3092 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
3093 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
3094 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
3095 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
3096 *
3097 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
3098 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
3099 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
3100 * disconnect normally later.
3101 *
3102 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
3103 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
3104 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
3105 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
3106 */
3107void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3108
3109/**
3110 * ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps - force mac80211 to temporarily disable dynamic psm
3111 *
3112 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3113 *
3114 * Some hardware require full power save to manage simultaneous BT traffic
3115 * on the WLAN frequency. Full PSM is required periodically, whenever there are
3116 * burst of BT traffic. The hardware gets information of BT traffic via
3117 * hardware co-existence lines, and consequentially requests mac80211 to
3118 * (temporarily) enter full psm.
3119 * This function will only temporarily disable dynamic PS, not enable PSM if
3120 * it was not already enabled.
3121 * The driver must make sure to re-enable dynamic PS using
3122 * ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps() if the driver has disabled it.
3123 *
3124 */
3125void ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3126
3127/**
3128 * ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps - restore dynamic psm after being disabled
3129 *
3130 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3131 *
3132 * This function restores dynamic PS after being temporarily disabled via
3133 * ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps(). Each ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps() call must
3134 * be coupled with an eventual call to this function.
3135 *
3136 */
3137void ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3138
3139/**
3140 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
3141 *	rssi threshold triggered
3142 *
3143 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3144 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
 
3145 * @gfp: context flags
3146 *
3147 * When the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
3148 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
3149 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
3150 */
3151void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3152			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
 
3153			       gfp_t gfp);
3154
3155/**
3156 * ieee80211_get_operstate - get the operstate of the vif
3157 *
3158 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
 
 
 
 
3159 *
3160 * The driver might need to know the operstate of the net_device
3161 * (specifically, whether the link is IF_OPER_UP after resume)
3162 */
3163unsigned char ieee80211_get_operstate(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3164
3165/**
3166 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
3167 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3168 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
3169 *
3170 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
3171 * and wake up the suspended queues.
3172 */
3173void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
3174
3175/**
3176 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
3177 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3178 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
3179 *
3180 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
3181 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
3182 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
3183 */
3184void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3185			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
3186
3187/**
3188 * ieee80211_key_removed - disable hw acceleration for key
3189 * @key_conf: The key hw acceleration should be disabled for
3190 *
3191 * This allows drivers to indicate that the given key has been
3192 * removed from hardware acceleration, due to a new key that
3193 * was added. Don't use this if the key can continue to be used
3194 * for TX, if the key restriction is on RX only it is permitted
3195 * to keep the key for TX only and not call this function.
3196 *
3197 * Due to locking constraints, it may only be called during
3198 * @set_key. This function must be allowed to sleep, and the
3199 * key it tries to disable may still be used until it returns.
3200 */
3201void ieee80211_key_removed(struct ieee80211_key_conf *key_conf);
3202
3203/**
3204 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
3205 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3206 */
3207void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3208
3209/**
3210 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
3211 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3212 */
3213void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3214
3215/**
3216 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
3217 *
3218 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
3219 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
3220 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
3221 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
3222 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
3223 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
3224 *
3225 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3226 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
3227 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
3228 */
3229void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
3230				  const u8 *addr);
3231
3232/* Rate control API */
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3233
3234/**
3235 * enum rate_control_changed - flags to indicate which parameter changed
3236 *
3237 * @IEEE80211_RC_HT_CHANGED: The HT parameters of the operating channel have
3238 *	changed, rate control algorithm can update its internal state if needed.
 
 
 
 
 
3239 */
3240enum rate_control_changed {
3241	IEEE80211_RC_HT_CHANGED = BIT(0)
3242};
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3243
3244/**
3245 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
3246 *
3247 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
3248 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
3249 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
 
 
3250 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
3251 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
3252 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
3253 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
3254 *	RTS threshold
3255 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
3256 *	if the selected rate supports it
3257 * @max_rate_idx: user-requested maximum rate (not MCS for now)
3258 *	(deprecated; this will be removed once drivers get updated to use
3259 *	rate_idx_mask)
3260 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested rate mask (not MCS for now)
3261 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
3262 *	to be filled in
3263 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
3264 */
3265struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
3266	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
3267	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
3268	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
3269	struct sk_buff *skb;
3270	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
3271	bool rts, short_preamble;
3272	u8 max_rate_idx;
3273	u32 rate_idx_mask;
 
3274	bool bss;
3275};
3276
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3277struct rate_control_ops {
3278	struct module *module;
3279	const char *name;
3280	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir);
 
 
3281	void (*free)(void *priv);
3282
3283	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
3284	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 
3285			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
3286	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3287			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3288			    void *priv_sta, u32 changed,
3289			    enum nl80211_channel_type oper_chan_type);
3290	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3291			 void *priv_sta);
3292
 
 
 
3293	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3294			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
3295			  struct sk_buff *skb);
3296	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
3297			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
3298
3299	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
3300				struct dentry *dir);
3301	void (*remove_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta);
 
3302};
3303
3304static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3305				 enum ieee80211_band band,
3306				 int index)
3307{
3308	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
3309}
3310
3311/**
3312 * rate_control_send_low - helper for drivers for management/no-ack frames
3313 *
3314 * Rate control algorithms that agree to use the lowest rate to
3315 * send management frames and NO_ACK data with the respective hw
3316 * retries should use this in the beginning of their mac80211 get_rate
3317 * callback. If true is returned the rate control can simply return.
3318 * If false is returned we guarantee that sta and sta and priv_sta is
3319 * not null.
3320 *
3321 * Rate control algorithms wishing to do more intelligent selection of
3322 * rate for multicast/broadcast frames may choose to not use this.
3323 *
3324 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. Note
3325 * 	that this may be null.
3326 * @priv_sta: private rate control structure. This may be null.
3327 * @txrc: rate control information we sholud populate for mac80211.
3328 */
3329bool rate_control_send_low(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3330			   void *priv_sta,
3331			   struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
3332
3333
3334static inline s8
3335rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3336		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
3337{
3338	int i;
3339
3340	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
3341		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
3342			return i;
3343
3344	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
3345	WARN_ON(1);
3346
 
3347	return 0;
3348}
3349
3350static inline
3351bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3352			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
3353{
3354	unsigned int i;
3355
3356	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
3357		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
3358			return true;
3359	return false;
3360}
3361
3362int ieee80211_rate_control_register(struct rate_control_ops *ops);
3363void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(struct rate_control_ops *ops);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3364
3365static inline bool
3366conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3367{
3368	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
3369}
3370
3371static inline bool
3372conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3373{
3374	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
 
3375}
3376
3377static inline bool
3378conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3379{
3380	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
 
3381}
3382
3383static inline bool
3384conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3385{
3386	return conf_is_ht40_minus(conf) || conf_is_ht40_plus(conf);
3387}
3388
3389static inline bool
3390conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3391{
3392	return conf->channel_type != NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 
 
3393}
3394
3395static inline enum nl80211_iftype
3396ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
3397{
3398	if (p2p) {
3399		switch (type) {
3400		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
3401			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
3402		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
3403			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
3404		default:
3405			break;
3406		}
3407	}
3408	return type;
3409}
3410
3411static inline enum nl80211_iftype
3412ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
3413{
3414	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
3415}
3416
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3417void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3418				   int rssi_min_thold,
3419				   int rssi_max_thold);
3420
3421void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3422#endif /* MAC80211_H */
v5.9
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2020 Intel Corporation
 
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
 
 
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  22#include <net/codel.h>
  23#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  24#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  25
  26/**
  27 * DOC: Introduction
  28 *
  29 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  30 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  31 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  32 * drivers.
  33 */
  34
  35/**
  36 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  37 *
  38 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  39 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  40 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  41 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  42 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  43 * tasklet function.
  44 *
  45 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  46 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  47 */
  48
  49/**
  50 * DOC: Warning
  51 *
  52 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  53 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  54 */
  55
  56/**
  57 * DOC: Frame format
  58 *
  59 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  60 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  61 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  62 * hardware.
  63 *
  64 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  65 *
  66 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  67 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  68 *
  69 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  70 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
 
 
 
 
  71 */
  72
  73/**
  74 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  75 *
  76 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  77 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  78 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  79 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  80 *
  81 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  82 * suspend.
  83 *
  84 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  85 *
  86 */
  87
  88/**
  89 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  90 *
  91 * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
  92 * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
  93 * between different stations/interfaces.
  94 * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
  95 * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
  96 * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
  97 *
  98 * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
  99 * driver operation.
 100 *
 101 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 102 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 103 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 104 *
 105 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 106 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 107 *
 108 * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame from a
 109 * txq, it calls ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a
 110 * queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
 111 *
 112 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 113 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 114 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 115 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 116 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 117 *
 118 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 119 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 120 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 121 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 122 * .release_buffered_frames().
 123 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 124 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 125 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 126 */
 127
 128struct device;
 129
 130/**
 131 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 132 *
 133 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 134 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 135 */
 136enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 137	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 138	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 139};
 140
 141#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 142
 143/**
 144 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 145 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 146 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 147 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 148 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 149 */
 150enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 151	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 152	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 153	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 154	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 155};
 156
 157/**
 158 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 159 *
 160 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 161 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 162 *
 163 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 164 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 165 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 166 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 167 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 168 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 169 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 170 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 171 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 172 */
 173struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 174	u16 txop;
 175	u16 cw_min;
 176	u16 cw_max;
 177	u8 aifs;
 178	bool acm;
 179	bool uapsd;
 180	bool mu_edca;
 181	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 182};
 183
 184struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 185	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 186	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 187	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 188	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 189};
 190
 191/**
 192 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 193 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 194 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 195 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 196 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 197 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 198 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 199 */
 200enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 201	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 202	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 203	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 204	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 205	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 206};
 207
 208/**
 209 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 210 *
 211 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 212 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 213 *
 214 * @def: the channel definition
 215 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 216 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 217 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 218 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 219 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 220 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 221 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 222 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 223 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 224 */
 225struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 226	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 227	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 228
 229	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 230
 231	bool radar_enabled;
 232
 233	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 234};
 235
 236/**
 237 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 238 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 239 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 240 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 241 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 242 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 243 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 244 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 245 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 246 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 247 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 248 *      for changes/removal.)
 249 */
 250enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 251	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 252	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 253};
 254
 255/**
 256 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 257 *
 258 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 259 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 260 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 261 * done.
 262 *
 263 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 264 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 265 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 266 */
 267struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 268	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 269	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 270	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 271};
 272
 273/**
 274 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 275 *
 276 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
 277 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
 278 *
 279 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 280 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 281 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 282 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 283 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 284 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 285 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 286 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 287 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 288 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 289 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 290 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 291 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 292 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 293 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 294 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 295 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 296 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 297 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 298 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 300 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 304 *	changed
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 306 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 308 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 309 *	context had been assigned.
 310 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 312 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 313 *	keep alive) changed.
 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 316 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 317 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 320 *
 321 */
 322enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 323	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 324	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 325	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 326	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 327	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 328	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 329	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 330	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 331	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 332	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 333	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 334	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 335	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 336	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 337	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 338	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 339	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 340	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 341	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 342	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 343	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 344	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 345	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 346	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 347	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 348	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 349	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 350	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 351	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 352	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 353
 354	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 355};
 356
 357/*
 358 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 359 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 360 * filtering will be disabled.
 361 */
 362#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 363
 364/**
 365 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 366 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 367 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 368 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 369 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 370 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 371 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 372 */
 373enum ieee80211_event_type {
 374	RSSI_EVENT,
 375	MLME_EVENT,
 376	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 377	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 378};
 379
 380/**
 381 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 382 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 383 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 384 */
 385enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 386	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 387	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 388};
 389
 390/**
 391 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 392 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 393 */
 394struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 395	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 396};
 397
 398/**
 399 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 400 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 401 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 402 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 403 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 404 */
 405enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 406	AUTH_EVENT,
 407	ASSOC_EVENT,
 408	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 409	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 410};
 411
 412/**
 413 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 414 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 415 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 416 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 417 */
 418enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 419	MLME_SUCCESS,
 420	MLME_DENIED,
 421	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 422};
 423
 424/**
 425 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 426 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 427 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 428 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 429 */
 430struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 431	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 432	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 433	u16 reason;
 434};
 435
 436/**
 437 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 438 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 439 * @tid: the tid
 440 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 441 */
 442struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 443	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 444	u16 tid;
 445	u16 ssn;
 446};
 447
 448/**
 449 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 450 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 451 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 452 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 453 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 454 * @u:union holding the fields above
 455 */
 456struct ieee80211_event {
 457	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 458	union {
 459		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 460		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 461		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 462	} u;
 463};
 464
 465/**
 466 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 467 *
 468 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 469 *
 470 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 471 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 472 */
 473struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 474	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 475	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 476};
 477
 478/**
 479 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 480 *
 481 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 482 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 483 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 484 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 485 */
 486struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 487	const u8 *lci;
 488	const u8 *civicloc;
 489	size_t lci_len;
 490	size_t civicloc_len;
 491};
 492
 493/**
 494 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 495 *
 496 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 497 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 498 *
 499 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 500 * @multi_sta_back_32bit: supports BA bitmap of 32-bits in Multi-STA BACK
 501 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 502 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
 503 *	ACK, BACK or both
 504 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 505 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 506 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 507 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 508 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 509 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 510 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 511 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 512 * @assoc: association status
 513 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
 514 *	or not
 515 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
 516 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 517 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 518 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 519 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 
 
 
 
 520 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 521 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 522 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 523 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 524 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 525 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 526 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 527 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 528 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 529 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 530 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 531 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 532 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 533 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 534 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 535 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 536 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 537 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 538 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 539 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 540 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 541 *	the current band.
 542 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 543 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 544 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 545 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 546 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 547 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 548 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 549 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 550 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 551 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 552 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 553 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 554 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 555 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 556 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 557 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 558 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 559 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 560 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 561 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 562 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 563 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 564 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 565 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 566 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
 567 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
 568 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
 
 
 569 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 570 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 571 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 572 *	your driver/device needs to do.
 573 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
 574 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
 575 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
 576 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
 577 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 578 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 579 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 580 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 581 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 582 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 583 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 584 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 585 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 586 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 587 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 588 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 589 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 590 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 591 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 592 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 593 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 594 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 595 *	station.
 596 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 597 *	responder functionality.
 598 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 599 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 600 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 601 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 602 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 603 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 604 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 605 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 606 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 607 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the AP we are connected to
 608 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 609 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 610 */
 611struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 612	const u8 *bssid;
 613	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 614	bool multi_sta_back_32bit;
 615	bool uora_exists;
 616	bool ack_enabled;
 617	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 618	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 619	bool he_support;
 620	bool twt_requester;
 621	bool twt_responder;
 622	bool twt_protected;
 623	/* association related data */
 624	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
 625	bool ibss_creator;
 626	u16 aid;
 627	/* erp related data */
 628	bool use_cts_prot;
 629	bool use_short_preamble;
 630	bool use_short_slot;
 631	bool enable_beacon;
 632	u8 dtim_period;
 633	u16 beacon_int;
 634	u16 assoc_capability;
 635	u64 sync_tsf;
 636	u32 sync_device_ts;
 637	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 638	u32 basic_rates;
 639	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 640	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 641	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 642	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 643	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 644	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 645	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 646	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 647	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 648	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
 649	int arp_addr_cnt;
 
 650	bool qos;
 651	bool idle;
 652	bool ps;
 653	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
 654	size_t ssid_len;
 655	bool hidden_ssid;
 656	int txpower;
 657	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 658	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 659	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 660	u16 max_idle_period;
 661	bool protected_keep_alive;
 662	bool ftm_responder;
 663	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 664	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 665	bool nontransmitted;
 666	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 667	u8 bssid_index;
 668	u8 bssid_indicator;
 669	bool ema_ap;
 670	u8 profile_periodicity;
 671	struct {
 672		u32 params;
 673		u16 nss_set;
 674	} he_oper;
 675	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 676	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 677};
 678
 679/**
 680 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 681 *
 682 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 683 *
 684 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 685 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 686 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 687 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 688 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 689 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 690 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 691 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 692 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 693 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 694 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 695 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 696 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 697 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 698 *	station
 699 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 700 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 701 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 702 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 703 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 704 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 705 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 706 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 707 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 708 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 709 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 710 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 711 *	hardware queue.
 712 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 713 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 714 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 715 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 716 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 717 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 718 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 719 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 720 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 721 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 722 *	off-channel operation.
 723 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 724 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 725 *	it can be sent out.
 726 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 727 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 728 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 729 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 730 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 731 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 732 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 733 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 734 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 735 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 736 *	queue gets full.
 737 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 738 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 739 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 740 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 741 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 742 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 743 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 744 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 745 *	status to user space)
 746 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 747 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 748 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 749 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 750 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 751 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 752 *	handled properly by the device.
 753 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 754 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 755 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 756 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 757 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 758 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 759 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 760 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 761 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 762 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 763 *	PS-Poll responses.
 764 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 765 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 766 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 767 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 768 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 769 *	monitor injection).
 770 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 771 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 772 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 773 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 774 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 775 *
 776 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 777 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 778 */
 779enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 780	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 781	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 782	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 783	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 784	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 785	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 786	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 787	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 788	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 789	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 790	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 791	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 792	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 793	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 794	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(14),
 795	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 796	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 797	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 798	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 799	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 800	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 801	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 802	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 803	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 804	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 805	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 806	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 807	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 808	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 809	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 810	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 811};
 812
 813#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 814
 815/**
 816 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 817 *
 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 819 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 820 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 821 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 822 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 823 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 824 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 826 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 827 *	(header conversion)
 828 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 829 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
 830 *
 831 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 832 */
 833enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 834	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 835	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 836	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 837	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 838	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 839	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
 840	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_HW_80211_ENCAP	= BIT(6),
 841	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
 842};
 843
 844/*
 845 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 846 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 847 */
 848#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 849	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 850	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 851	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 852	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 853	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 854	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 855	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 856
 857/**
 858 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 859 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 860 *
 861 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 862 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 863 *
 864 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 865 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 866 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 867 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 868 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 869 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 870 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 872 *	Greenfield mode.
 873 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 874 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 875 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 876 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
 877 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 878 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 879 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 880 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 881 */
 882enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 883	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 884	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 885	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 886
 887	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
 888	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 889	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 890	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 891	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 892	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 893	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
 894	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
 895	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
 896};
 897
 898
 899/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 900#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 901
 902/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 903#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 904
 905/* maximum number of rate stages */
 906#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
 907
 908/* maximum number of rate table entries */
 909#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
 910
 911/**
 912 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 913 *
 914 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 915 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 916 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 917 *
 918 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 919 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 920 *
 921 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 922 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 923 *
 924 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 925 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 926 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 927 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 928 * information::
 929 *
 930 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 931 *
 932 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 933 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 934 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 935 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 936 * information should then contain::
 937 *
 938 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 939 *
 940 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 941 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 942 */
 943struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
 944	s8 idx;
 945	u16 count:5,
 946	    flags:11;
 947} __packed;
 948
 949#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
 950
 951static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
 952					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
 953{
 954	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
 955	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
 956	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
 957}
 958
 959static inline u8
 960ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 961{
 962	return rate->idx & 0xF;
 963}
 964
 965static inline u8
 966ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 967{
 968	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
 969}
 970
 971/**
 972 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 973 *
 974 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 975 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 976 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 977 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 978 *
 
 
 
 979 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 980 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
 981 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
 982 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
 983 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
 984 * @control: union part for control data
 985 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
 986 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
 987 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
 988 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
 989 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
 990 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
 991 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
 992 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
 993 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
 994 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
 995 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
 996 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
 997 * @pad: padding
 998 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
 999 * @status: union part for status data
1000 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1001 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1002 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1003 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1004 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1005 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission
1006 * @status.is_valid_ack_signal: ACK signal is valid
1007 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1008 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1009 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1010 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1011 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1012 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1013 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1014 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1015 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1016 */
1017struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1018	/* common information */
1019	u32 flags;
1020	u32 band:3,
1021	    ack_frame_id:13,
1022	    hw_queue:4,
1023	    tx_time_est:10;
1024	/* 2 free bits */
 
1025
1026	union {
1027		struct {
1028			union {
1029				/* rate control */
1030				struct {
1031					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1032						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1033					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1034					u8 use_rts:1;
1035					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1036					u8 short_preamble:1;
1037					u8 skip_table:1;
1038					/* 2 bytes free */
1039				};
1040				/* only needed before rate control */
1041				unsigned long jiffies;
1042			};
1043			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1044			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1045			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1046			u32 flags;
1047			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1048		} control;
1049		struct {
1050			u64 cookie;
1051		} ack;
1052		struct {
1053			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1054			s32 ack_signal;
1055			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
 
1056			u8 ampdu_len;
1057			u8 antenna;
1058			u16 tx_time;
1059			bool is_valid_ack_signal;
1060			void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
1061		} status;
1062		struct {
1063			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1064				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1065			u8 pad[4];
1066
1067			void *rate_driver_data[
1068				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1069		};
1070		void *driver_data[
1071			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1072	};
1073};
1074
1075static inline u16
1076ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1077{
1078	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1079	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1080	 */
1081	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1082	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1083}
1084
1085static inline u16
1086ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1087{
1088	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1089}
1090
1091/**
1092 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1093 *
1094 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1095 * @info: Basic tx status information
1096 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1097 * @rate: The TX rate that was used when sending the packet
1098 */
1099struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1100	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1101	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1102	struct sk_buff *skb;
1103	struct rate_info *rate;
1104};
1105
1106/**
1107 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1108 *
1109 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1110 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1111 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1112 *
1113 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1114 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1115 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1116 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1117 */
1118struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1119	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1120	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1121	const u8 *common_ies;
1122	size_t common_ie_len;
1123};
1124
1125
1126static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1127{
1128	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1129}
1130
1131static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1132{
1133	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1134}
1135
1136/**
1137 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1138 *
1139 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1140 *
1141 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1142 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1143 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1144 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1145 *
1146 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1147 *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1148 *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1149 */
1150static inline void
1151ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1152{
1153	int i;
1154
1155	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1156		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1157	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1158		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1159	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1160	/* clear the rate counts */
1161	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1162		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1163
1164	BUILD_BUG_ON(
1165	    offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20);
1166	memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
1167	       sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
1168	       offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
1169}
1170
1171
1172/**
1173 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1174 *
1175 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1176 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1177 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1178 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1179 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1180 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1181 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1182 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1183 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1184 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1185 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1186 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1187 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1188 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1189 *	de-duplication by itself.
1190 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1191 *	the frame.
1192 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1193 *	the frame.
1194 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1195 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1196 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1197 *	merging.
1198 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1199 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1200 *	(including FCS) was received.
1201 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1202 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1203 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1204 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1205 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1206 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1207 *	each A-MPDU
1208 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1209 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1210 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1211 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1212 *	on this subframe
1213 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1214 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1215 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1216 *	done by the hardware
1217 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1218 *	processing it in any regular way.
1219 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1220 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1221 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1222 *	monitor interfaces.
1223 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1224 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1225 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1226 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1227 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1228 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1229 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1230 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1231 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1232 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1233 *	interleaved with other frames.
1234 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1235 *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1236 *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1237 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1238 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1239 *	the first subframe.
1240 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1241 *	be done in the hardware.
1242 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1243 *	frame
1244 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1245 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1246 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1247 *	
1248 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1249 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1250 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1251 *	 - DATA5_GI
1252 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1253 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1254 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1255 *	
1256 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1257 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1258 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1259 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1260 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1261 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1262 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1263 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1264 */
1265enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1266	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1267	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1268	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1269	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1270	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1271	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1272	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1273	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1274	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1275	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1276	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1277	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1278	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1279	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1280	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1281	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1282	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1283	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1284	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1285	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1286	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1287	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1288	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1289	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1290	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1291	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1292	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1293	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1294	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1295	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1296};
1297
1298/**
1299 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1300 *
1301 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1302 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1303 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1304 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1305 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1306 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1307 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1308 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1309 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1310 */
1311enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1312	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1313	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1314	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1315	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1316	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1317	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1318};
1319
1320#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1321
1322enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1323	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1324	RX_ENC_HT,
1325	RX_ENC_VHT,
1326	RX_ENC_HE,
1327};
1328
1329/**
1330 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1331 *
1332 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1333 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1334 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1335 *
1336 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1337 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1338 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1339 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1340 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1341 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1342 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1343 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1344 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1345 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1346 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1347 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1348 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1349 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1350 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1351 *	values were filled.
1352 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1353 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1354 * @antenna: antenna used
1355 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1356 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1357 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1358 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1359 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1360 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1361 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1362 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1363 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1364 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1365 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1366 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1367 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1368 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1369 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1370 */
1371struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1372	u64 mactime;
1373	u64 boottime_ns;
1374	u32 device_timestamp;
1375	u32 ampdu_reference;
1376	u32 flag;
1377	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1378	u8 enc_flags;
1379	u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1380	u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
1381	u8 rate_idx;
1382	u8 nss;
1383	u8 rx_flags;
1384	u8 band;
1385	u8 antenna;
1386	s8 signal;
1387	u8 chains;
1388	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1389	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1390	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1391};
1392
1393static inline u32
1394ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1395{
1396	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1397	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1398}
1399
1400/**
1401 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1402 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1403 *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1404 *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1405 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1406 *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1407 *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1408 *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1409 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1410 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1411 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1412 *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1413 *	@data field.
1414 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1415 *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1416 *	length
1417 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1418 *
1419 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1420 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1421 * data.
1422 */
1423struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1424	u32 present;
1425	u8 align;
1426	u8 oui[3];
1427	u8 subns;
1428	u8 pad;
1429	u16 len;
1430	u8 data[];
1431} __packed;
1432
1433/**
1434 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1435 *
1436 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1437 *
1438 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1439 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1440 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1441 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1442 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1443 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1444 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1445 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1446 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1447 *	for more.
1448 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1449 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1450 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1451 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1452 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1453 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1454 *	operating channel.
1455 */
1456enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1457	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1458	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1459	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1460	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1461};
1462
1463
1464/**
1465 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1466 *
1467 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1468 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1469 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1470 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1471 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1472 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1473 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1474 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1475 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1476 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1477 */
1478enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1479	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1480	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1481	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1482	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1483	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1484	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1485	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1486	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1487};
1488
1489/**
1490 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1491 *
1492 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1493 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1494 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1495 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1496 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1497 */
1498enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1499	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1500	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1501	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1502	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1503
1504	/* keep last */
1505	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1506};
1507
1508/**
1509 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1510 *
1511 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1512 *
1513 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1514 *
1515 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
 
 
 
 
 
1516 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1517 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1518 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1519 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1520 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1521 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1522 *
1523 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1524 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1525 *
1526 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1527 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1528 *
1529 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1530 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1531 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1532 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1533 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1534 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1535 *
1536 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1537 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1538 *	configured for an HT channel.
1539 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1540 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1541 */
1542struct ieee80211_conf {
1543	u32 flags;
1544	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
 
1545
1546	u16 listen_interval;
1547	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1548
1549	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1550
1551	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1552	bool radar_enabled;
1553	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1554};
1555
1556/**
1557 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1558 *
1559 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1560 * operation.
1561 *
1562 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1563 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1564 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1565 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1566 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1567 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1568 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1569 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1570 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1571 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1572 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1573  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1574  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1575 */
1576struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1577	u64 timestamp;
1578	u32 device_timestamp;
1579	bool block_tx;
1580	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1581	u8 count;
1582	u32 delay;
1583};
1584
1585/**
1586 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1587 *
1588 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1589 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1590 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1591 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1592 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1593 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1594 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1595 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1596 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1597 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1598 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1599 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1600 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1601 */
1602enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1603	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1604	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1605	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1606	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1607};
1608
1609/**
1610 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1611 *
1612 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1613 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1614 *
1615 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1616 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1617 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1618 * @addr: address of this interface
1619 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1620 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1621 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1622 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1623 *	for read access.
1624 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1625 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1626 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1627 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1628 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1629 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1630 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1631 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1632 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1633 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1634 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1635 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1636 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1637 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1638 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1639 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1640 *	interface.
1641 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1642 *	for this interface.
1643 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1644 *	sizeof(void \*).
1645 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1646 * @txqs_stopped: per AC flag to indicate that intermediate TXQs are stopped,
1647 *	protected by fq->lock.
1648 */
1649struct ieee80211_vif {
1650	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1651	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1652	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1653	bool p2p;
1654	bool csa_active;
1655	bool mu_mimo_owner;
1656
1657	u8 cab_queue;
1658	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1659
1660	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1661
1662	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1663
1664	u32 driver_flags;
1665
1666#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1667	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1668#endif
1669
1670	bool probe_req_reg;
1671	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1672
1673	bool txqs_stopped[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1674
1675	/* must be last */
1676	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1677};
1678
1679static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1680{
1681#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1682	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1683#endif
1684	return false;
1685}
1686
1687/**
1688 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1689 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1690 *
1691 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1692 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1693 *
1694 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1695 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1696 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1697 */
1698struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1699
1700/**
1701 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1702 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1703 *
1704 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1705 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1706 *
1707 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1708 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1709 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1710 */
1711struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1712
1713/**
1714 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1715 *
1716 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1717 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1718 *
 
 
1719 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1720 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1721 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1722 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1723 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1724 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1725 *	generation in software.
1726 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1727 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1728 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1729 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1730 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1731 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1732 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1733 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1734 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1735 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1736 *	MIC.
1737 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1738 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1739 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1740 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1741 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1742 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1743 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1744 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1745 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1746 *	only for management frames (MFP).
1747 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1748 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1749 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1750 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1751 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1752 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1753 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1754 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1755 *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1756 *	generation only
1757 */
1758enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1759	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1760	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1761	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1762	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1763	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1764	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1765	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1766	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1767	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1768	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
1769	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
1770};
1771
1772/**
1773 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1774 *
1775 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1776 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1777 *
1778 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1779 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1780 *	encrypted in hardware.
1781 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1782 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1783 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1784 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1785 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1786 * @keylen: key material length
1787 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1788 * 	data block:
1789 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1790 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1791 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1792 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1793 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1794 */
1795struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1796	atomic64_t tx_pn;
1797	u32 cipher;
1798	u8 icv_len;
1799	u8 iv_len;
1800	u8 hw_key_idx;
 
1801	s8 keyidx;
1802	u16 flags;
1803	u8 keylen;
1804	u8 key[];
1805};
1806
1807#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
1808
1809#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1810#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1811
1812/**
1813 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1814 *
1815 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1816 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1817 *	reverse order than in packet)
1818 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1819 *	reverse order than in packet)
1820 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1821 *	reverse order than in packet)
1822 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1823 *	reverse order than in packet)
1824 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1825 */
1826struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1827	union {
1828		struct {
1829			u32 iv32;
1830			u16 iv16;
1831		} tkip;
1832		struct {
1833			u8 pn[6];
1834		} ccmp;
1835		struct {
1836			u8 pn[6];
1837		} aes_cmac;
1838		struct {
1839			u8 pn[6];
1840		} aes_gmac;
1841		struct {
1842			u8 pn[6];
1843		} gcmp;
1844		struct {
1845			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1846			u8 seq_len;
1847		} hw;
1848	};
1849};
1850
1851/**
1852 * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1853 *
1854 * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1855 * the secure packet crypto handling.
1856 *
1857 * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1858 * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1859 * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1860 * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1861 * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1862 * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1863 * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1864 * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1865 *     key_idx value calculation:
1866 *      (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1867 * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1868 */
1869struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1870	u32 cipher;
1871	u16 iftype;
1872	u8 hdr_len;
1873	u8 pn_len;
1874	u8 pn_off;
1875	u8 key_idx_off;
1876	u8 key_idx_mask;
1877	u8 key_idx_shift;
1878	u8 mic_len;
1879};
1880
1881/**
1882 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1883 *
1884 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1885 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1886 *
1887 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1888 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1889 */
1890enum set_key_cmd {
1891	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1892};
1893
1894/**
1895 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1896 *
1897 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1898 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1899 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1900 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1901 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1902 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1903 */
1904enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1905	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1906	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1907	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1908	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1909	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1910	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1911};
1912
1913/**
1914 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1915 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1916 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1917 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1918 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1919 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
1920 *
1921 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1922 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
1923 */
1924enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
1925	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
1926	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
1927	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
1928	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
1929};
1930
1931/**
1932 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
1933 *
1934 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
1935 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
1936 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
1937 */
1938struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
1939	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
1940	struct {
1941		s8 idx;
1942		u8 count;
1943		u8 count_cts;
1944		u8 count_rts;
1945		u16 flags;
1946	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
1947};
1948
1949/**
1950 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1951 *
1952 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1953 *
1954 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
1955 *	to the STA.
1956 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1957 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1958 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1959 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1960 *	per peer TPC.
1961 */
1962struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
1963	s16 power;
1964	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1965};
1966
1967/**
1968 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
1969 *
1970 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
1971 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
1972 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
1973 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
1974 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
1975 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
1976 *
1977 * @addr: MAC address
1978 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
1979 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
1980 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1981 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1982 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
1983 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
1984 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
1985 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
1986 *	Can be modified by driver.
1987 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
1988 *	otherwise always false)
1989 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1990 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
1991 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
1992 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
1993 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
1994 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
1995 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
1996 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
1997 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
1998 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
1999 *	the station moves to associated state.
2000 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2001 * @rates: rate control selection table
2002 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2003 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2004 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2005 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2006 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2007 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2008 *	unlimited.
2009 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2010 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2011 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2012 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2013 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction); note that
2014 *	the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) is used for non-data frames
2015 */
2016struct ieee80211_sta {
2017	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2018	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2019	u16 aid;
2020	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2021	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2022	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2023	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2024	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2025	bool wme;
2026	u8 uapsd_queues;
2027	u8 max_sp;
2028	u8 rx_nss;
2029	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2030	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2031	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2032	bool tdls;
2033	bool tdls_initiator;
2034	bool mfp;
2035	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2036
2037	/**
2038	 * @max_amsdu_len:
2039	 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2040	 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2041	 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2042	 *
2043	 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2044	 *   A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2045	 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2046	 *   size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2047	 *
2048	 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2049	 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2050	 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2051	 */
2052	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2053	bool support_p2p_ps;
2054	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2055	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2056	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2057
2058	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2059
2060	/* must be last */
2061	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2062};
2063
2064/**
2065 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2066 *
2067 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2068 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2069 *
2070 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2071 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2072 */
2073enum sta_notify_cmd {
2074	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2075};
2076
2077/**
2078 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2079 *
2080 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2081 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2082 */
2083struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2084	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2085};
2086
2087/**
2088 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2089 *
2090 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2091 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2092 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2093 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2094 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2095 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2096 *
2097 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2098 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2099 */
2100struct ieee80211_txq {
2101	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2102	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2103	u8 tid;
2104	u8 ac;
2105
2106	/* must be last */
2107	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2108};
2109
2110/**
2111 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2112 *
2113 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2114 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2115 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2116 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2117 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2118 *
2119 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2120 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2121 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2122 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2123 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2124 *	algorithm.
2125 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2126 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2127 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2128 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2129 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2130 *	CCK frames.
2131 *
2132 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2133 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2134 *	the FCS at the end.
2135 *
2136 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2137 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2138 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2139 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2140 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2141 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2142 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2143 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2144 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2145 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2146 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2147 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2148 *
2149 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2150 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2151 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2152 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2153 *
2154 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2155 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2156 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2157 *
2158 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2159 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2160 *
2161 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2162 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2163 *
2164 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2165 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2166 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2167 *
2168 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2169 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2170 *
2171 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2172 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2173 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2174 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2175 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2176 *	the stack.
2177 *
2178 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2179 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2180 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2181 *
2182 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2183 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2184 *	dtim_period).
2185 *
2186 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2187 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2188 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2189 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2190 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2191 *	only in that case.
2192 *
2193 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2194 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2195 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2196 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2197 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2198 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2199 *
2200 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2201 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2202 *	software.
2203 *
2204 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2205 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2206 *	active interfaces.
2207 *
2208 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2209 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2210 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2211 *
2212 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2213 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2214 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2215 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2216 *	supported cipher suites.
2217 *
2218 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2219 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2220 *	for frames.
2221 *
2222 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2223 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2224 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2225 *	control for more details.
2226 *
2227 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2228 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2229 *
2230 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2231 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2232 *	is supported.
2233 *
2234 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2235 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2236 *
2237 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2238 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2239 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2240 *
2241 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2242 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2243 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2244 *	CSA frame.
2245 *
2246 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2247 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2248 *
2249 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2250 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2251 *
2252 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2253 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2254 *
2255 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2256 *	within A-MPDU.
2257 *
2258 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2259 *	for sent beacons.
2260 *
2261 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2262 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2263 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2264 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2265 *
2266 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2267 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2268 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2269 *	timeout.
2270 *
2271 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2272 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2273 *
2274 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2275 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2276 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2277 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2278 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2279 *
2280 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2281 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2282 *
2283 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2284 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2285 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2286 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2287 *
2288 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2289 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2290 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2291 *
2292 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2293 *	TDLS links.
2294 *
2295 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2296 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2297 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2298 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2299 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2300 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2301 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2302 *
2303 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2304 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2305 *
2306 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2307 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2308 *
2309 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2310 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2311 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2312 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2313 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2314 *
2315 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2316 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2317 *	TXQs to start with.
2318 *
2319 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2320 *	length in tx status information
2321 *
2322 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2323 *
2324 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2325 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2326 *
2327 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2328 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2329 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2330 *
2331 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2332 */
2333enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2334	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2335	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2336	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2337	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2338	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2339	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2340	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2341	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2342	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2343	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2344	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2345	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2346	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2347	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2348	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2349	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2350	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2351	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2352	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2353	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2354	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2355	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2356	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2357	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2358	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2359	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2360	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2361	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2362	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2363	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2364	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2365	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2366	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2367	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2368	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2369	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2370	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2371	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2372	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2373	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2374	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2375	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2376	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2377	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2378	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2379	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2380	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2381	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2382	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2383
2384	/* keep last, obviously */
2385	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2386};
2387
2388/**
2389 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2390 *
2391 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2392 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2393 *
2394 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2395 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2396 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2397 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2398 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2399 *
2400 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2401 *
2402 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2403 *	along with this structure.
2404 *
2405 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2406 *
2407 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2408 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2409 *
2410 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2411 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2412 *
2413 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2414 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2415 *
2416 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2417 *	that HW supports
2418 *
2419 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2420 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2421 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2422 *
2423 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2424 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2425 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2426 *
2427 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2428 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2429 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2430 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2431 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2432 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2433 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2434 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2435 *
2436 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2437 *	can handle.
2438 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2439 *	the hw can report back.
2440 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2441 *
 
 
 
 
2442 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2443 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2444 *	aggregation.
2445 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2446 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2447 *	it shouldn't be set.
2448 *
2449 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2450 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2451 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2452 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2453 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2454 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2455 *
2456 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2457 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2458 *
2459 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2460 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2461 *
2462 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2463 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2464 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2465 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2466 *
2467 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2468 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2469 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2470 *
2471 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2472 *
2473 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2474 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2475 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2476 *	device_timestamp.
2477 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2478 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2479 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2480 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2481 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2482 *
2483 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2484 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2485 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2486 *
2487 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2488 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2489 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2490 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2491 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2492 *	neither enabled.
2493 *
2494 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2495 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2496 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2497 *
2498 * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2499 * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2500 *	supported by HW.
2501 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2502 *	device.
2503 *
2504 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2505 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2506 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2507 *
2508 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2509 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2510 *
2511 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2512 */
2513struct ieee80211_hw {
2514	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2515	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2516	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2517	void *priv;
2518	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2519	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2520	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2521	int vif_data_size;
2522	int sta_data_size;
2523	int chanctx_data_size;
2524	int txq_data_size;
2525	u16 queues;
2526	u16 max_listen_interval;
2527	s8 max_signal;
2528	u8 max_rates;
2529	u8 max_report_rates;
2530	u8 max_rate_tries;
2531	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2532	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2533	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2534	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2535	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2536	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2537	struct {
2538		int units_pos;
2539		s16 accuracy;
2540	} radiotap_timestamp;
2541	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2542	u8 uapsd_queues;
2543	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2544	u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2545	const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2546	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2547	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2548	u8 weight_multiplier;
2549	u32 max_mtu;
2550};
2551
2552static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2553				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2554{
2555	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2556}
2557#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2558
2559static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2560				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2561{
2562	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2563}
2564#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2565
2566/**
2567 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2568 *
2569 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2570 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2571 */
2572struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2573	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2574
2575	/* Keep last */
2576	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2577};
2578
2579/**
2580 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2581 *
2582 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2583 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2584 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2585 * @status: channel-switch response status
2586 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2587 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2588 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2589 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2590 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2591 */
2592struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2593	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2594	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2595	u8 action_code;
2596	u32 status;
2597	u32 timestamp;
2598	u16 switch_time;
2599	u16 switch_timeout;
2600	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2601	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2602};
2603
2604/**
2605 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2606 *
2607 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2608 *
2609 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2610 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2611 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2612 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2613 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2614 *
2615 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2616 */
2617struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2618
2619/**
2620 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2621 *
2622 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2623 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2624 */
2625static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2626{
2627	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2628}
2629
2630/**
2631 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2632 *
2633 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2634 * @addr: the address to set
2635 */
2636static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2637{
2638	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2639}
2640
2641static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2642ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2643		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2644{
2645	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2646		return NULL;
2647	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2648}
2649
2650static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2651ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2652			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2653{
2654	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2655		return NULL;
2656	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2657}
2658
2659static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2660ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2661			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2662{
2663	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2664		return NULL;
2665	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2666}
2667
2668/**
2669 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2670 * @hw: the hardware
2671 * @skb: the skb
2672 *
2673 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2674 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2675 */
2676void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2677
2678/**
2679 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2680 *
2681 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2682 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2683 *
2684 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2685 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2686 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2687 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2688 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2689 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2690 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2691 *
2692 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2693 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2694 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2695 *
2696 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2697 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2698 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2699 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2700 *
2701 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2702 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2703 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2704 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2705 *
2706 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2707 *
2708 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2709 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2710 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2711 * based on the receive flags.
2712 *
2713 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2714 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2715 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2716 * keys.
2717 *
2718 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2719 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2720 * handler.
2721 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2722 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2723 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2724 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2725 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2726 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2727 *
2728 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2729 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2730 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2731 *
2732 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
2733 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
2734 * requirements:
2735 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to
2736      mac80211 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been
2737      completed when also setting @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV for any key,
2738   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
2739      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
2740   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
2741      encrypted with the new key and
2742   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
2743   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
2744 */
2745
2746/**
2747 * DOC: Powersave support
2748 *
2749 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2750 *
2751 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2752 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2753 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2754 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2755 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2756 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2757 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2758 * it finds traffic directed to it.
2759 *
2760 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2761 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2762 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2763 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2764 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2765 *
2766 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2767 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2768 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2769 *
2770 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2771 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2772 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2773 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2774 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2775 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2776 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2777 *
2778 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2779 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2780 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2781 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2782 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2783 * periods.
2784 *
2785 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2786 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2787 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2788 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2789 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2790 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2791 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2792 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2793 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2794 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2795 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2796 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2797 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2798 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2799 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2800 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2801 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2802 *
2803 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2804 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2805 */
2806
2807/**
2808 * DOC: Beacon filter support
2809 *
2810 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2811 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2812 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2813 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2814 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2815 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2816 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2817 *
2818 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2819 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2820 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2821 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2822 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2823 *
2824 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2825 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2826 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2827 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2828 *
2829 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2830 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2831 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2832 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2833 *
2834 *  - a list of information element IDs
2835 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2836 *
2837 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2838 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2839 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2840 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2841 * vendor information elements.
2842 *
2843 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2844 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2845 *
2846 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2847 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2848 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2849 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2850 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2851 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2852 *
2853 *
2854 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2855 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2856 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2857 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2858 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2859 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2860 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2861 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2862 *
2863 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2864 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2865 * signal strength threshold checking.
2866 */
2867
2868/**
2869 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2870 *
2871 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2872 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2873 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2874 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2875 *
2876 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2877 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2878 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2879 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2880 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2881 * hardware flags.
2882 *
2883 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2884 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2885 * turned off otherwise.
2886 *
2887 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2888 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2889 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2890 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2891 */
2892
2893/**
2894 * DOC: Frame filtering
2895 *
2896 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2897 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2898 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2899 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2900 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2901 *
2902 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2903 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2904 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2905 *
2906 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2907 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
2908 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
2909 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
2910 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
2911 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
2912 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
2913 *
2914 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
2915 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
2916 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
2917 * or dropped.
2918 *
2919 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
2920 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
2921 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
2922 * the flag, but not clear it.
2923 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
2924 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
2925 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
2926 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
2927 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
2928 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
2929 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
2930 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
2931 */
2932
2933/**
2934 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
2935 *
2936 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
2937 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
2938 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
2939 *
2940 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
2941 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
2942 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
2943 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
2944 * the driver code.
2945 *
2946 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
2947 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
2948 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
2949 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
2950 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
2951 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
2952 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
2953 *
2954 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
2955 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
2956 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
2957 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
2958 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
2959 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
2960 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
2961 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
2962 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
2963 * @sta_notify callback.
2964 *
2965 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
2966 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
2967 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
2968 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
2969 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
2970 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
2971 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
2972 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
2973 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
2974 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
2975 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
2976 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
2977 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
2978 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
2979 *
2980 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
2981 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
2982 *
2983 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
2984 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
2985 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
2986 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
2987 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
2988 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
2989 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
2990 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
2991 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
2992 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
2993 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
2994 *
2995 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
2996 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
2997 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
2998 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
2999 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3000 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3001 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3002 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3003 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3004 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3005 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3006 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3007 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3008 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3009 *
3010 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3011 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3012 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3013 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3014 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3015 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3016 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3017 *
3018 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3019 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3020 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3021 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3022 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3023 *
3024 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3025 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3026 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3027 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3028 */
3029
3030/**
3031 * DOC: HW queue control
3032 *
3033 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3034 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3035 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3036 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3037 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3038 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3039 *
3040 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3041 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3042 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3043 *
3044 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3045 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3046 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3047 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3048 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3049 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3050 * the hardware queue.
3051 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3052 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3053 *
3054 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3055 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3056 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3057 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3058 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3059 *
3060 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3061 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3062 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3063 * off-channel queue:         9
3064 *
3065 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3066 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3067 *
3068 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3069 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3070 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3071 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3072 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3073 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3074 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3075 *
3076 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3077 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3078 *
3079 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3080 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3081 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3082 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3083 */
3084
3085/**
3086 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3087 *
3088 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3089 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3090 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3091 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3092 *
 
 
 
 
3093 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3094 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3095 *	multicast address.
3096 *
3097 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3098 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3099 *
3100 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3101 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3102 *
3103 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3104 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3105 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3106 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3107 *	honour this flag if possible.
3108 *
3109 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3110 *	station
3111 *
3112 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3113 *
3114 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
 
3115 *
3116 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3117 *
3118 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3119 */
3120enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
 
3121	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3122	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3123	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3124	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3125	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3126	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3127	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3128	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3129	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3130};
3131
3132/**
3133 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3134 *
3135 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3136 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3137 *
3138 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3139 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3140 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3141 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3142 *
3143 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3144 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3145 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3146 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3147 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3148 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3149 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3150 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3151 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3152 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3153 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3154 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3155 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3156 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3157 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3158 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3159 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3160 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3161 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3162 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3163 */
3164enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3165	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3166	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3167	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3168	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3169	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3170	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3171	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3172};
3173
3174#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3175#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3176
3177/**
3178 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3179 *
3180 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3181 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3182 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3183 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3184 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3185 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3186 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3187 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3188 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3189 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3190 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3191 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3192 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3193 */
3194struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3195	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3196	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3197	u16 tid;
3198	u16 ssn;
3199	u16 buf_size;
3200	bool amsdu;
3201	u16 timeout;
3202};
3203
3204/**
3205 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3206 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3207 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3208 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3209 */
3210enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3211	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3212	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3213};
3214
3215/**
3216 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3217 *
3218 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3219 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3220 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3221 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3222 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3223 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3224 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3225 *	the peer.
3226 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3227 *	by the peer
3228 */
3229enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3230	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3231	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3232	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3233	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3234};
3235
3236/**
3237 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3238 *
3239 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3240 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3241 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3242 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3243 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3244 *
3245 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3246 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3247 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3248 */
3249enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3250	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3251	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3252};
3253
3254/**
3255 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_complete_type - reconfig type
3256 *
3257 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3258 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3259 *
3260 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3261 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3262 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3263 *	of wowlan configuration)
3264 */
3265enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3266	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3267	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3268};
3269
3270/**
3271 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3272 *
3273 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3274 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3275 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3276 *
3277 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3278 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3279 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3280 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3281 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3282 *	Must be atomic.
 
 
 
3283 *
3284 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3285 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3286 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3287 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3288 *	or zero.
3289 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3290 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3291 *	is added.
3292 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3293 *
3294 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3295 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3296 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3297 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3298 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3299 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3300 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3301 *
3302 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3303 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3304 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3305 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3306 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3307 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3308 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3309 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3310 *	must return 1 from this function.
3311 *
3312 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3313 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3314 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3315 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3316 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3317 *
3318 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3319 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3320 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3321 *	in suspend().
3322 *
3323 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3324 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3325 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3326 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3327 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3328 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3329 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3330 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3331 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3332 *
3333 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3334 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3335 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3336 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3337 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3338 *
3339 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3340 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3341 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3342 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3343 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3344 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3345 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3346 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3347 *
3348 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3349 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3350 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3351 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3352 *
3353 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3354 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3355 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3356 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3357 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3358 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3359 *	can sleep.
3360 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3361 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3362 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3363 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3364 *
3365 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3366 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3367 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3368 *
3369 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3370 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3371 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3372 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3373 *	which flags are changed.
3374 *	This callback can sleep.
3375 *
3376 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3377 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3378 *
3379 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3380 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3381 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3382 *	is enabled.
3383 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3384 *	The callback can sleep.
3385 *
3386 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3387 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3388 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3389 *	The callback must be atomic.
3390 *
3391 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3392 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3393 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3394 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3395 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3396 *
3397 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3398 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3399 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3400 *
3401 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3402 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3403 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3404 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3405 *	that power save is disabled.
3406 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3407 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3408 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3409 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3410 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3411 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3412 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3413 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3414 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3415 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3416 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3417 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3418 *	The callback can sleep.
3419 *
3420 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3421 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3422 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3423 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3424 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3425 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3426 *	The callback can sleep.
3427 *
3428 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3429 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3430 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3431 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3432 *
3433 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3434 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3435 *
3436 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3437 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3438 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3439 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3440 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3441 *
3442 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3443 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3444 *	this notification.
3445 *	The callback can sleep.
3446 *
3447 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3448 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3449 *	The callback can sleep.
3450 *
3451 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3452 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3453 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3454 *	The callback must be atomic.
3455 *
3456 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3457 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3458 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3459 *	should be set as well.
3460 *	The callback can sleep.
3461 *
3462 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3463 *	The callback can sleep.
3464 *
3465 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3466 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3467 *
3468 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3469 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3470 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3471 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3472 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3473 *	This callback can sleep.
3474 *
3475 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3476 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3477 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3478 *	callback can sleep.
3479 *
3480 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3481 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3482 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3483 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3484 *
3485 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3486 *	power for the station.
3487 *	This callback can sleep.
3488 *
3489 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3490 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3491 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3492 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3493 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3494 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3495 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3496 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3497 *	The callback can sleep.
3498 *
3499 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3500 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3501 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3502 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3503 *	in @sta_state.
3504 *	The callback can sleep.
3505 *
3506 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3507 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3508 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3509 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3510 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3511 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3512 *	Must be atomic.
3513 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3514 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3515 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3516 *
3517 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3518 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3519 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3520 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3521 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3522 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3523 *	The callback can sleep.
3524 *
3525 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3526 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3527 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3528 *	The callback can sleep.
3529 *
3530 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3531 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3532 *	required function.
3533 *	The callback can sleep.
3534 *
3535 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3536 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3537 *	required function.
3538 *	The callback can sleep.
3539 *
3540 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3541 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3542 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3543 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3544 *	The callback can sleep.
3545 *
3546 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3547 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3548 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3549 *	TSF synchronization.
3550 *	The callback can sleep.
3551 *
3552 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3553 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3554 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3555 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3556 *	The callback can sleep.
3557 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3558 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3559 *
3560 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3561 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3562 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3563 *	The callback can sleep.
3564 *
3565 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3566 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3567 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3568 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3569 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3570 *
3571 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3572 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3573 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3574 *
3575 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3576 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3577 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3578 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3579 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3580 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3581 *	The callback can sleep.
3582 *
3583 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3584 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3585 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3586 *	completion of the channel switch.
3587 *
 
 
3588 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3589 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3590 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3591 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3592 *
3593 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3594 *
3595 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3596 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3597 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3598 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3599 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3600 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3601 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3602 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3603 *	must be accepted in this case.
3604 *	This callback may sleep.
3605 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3606 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
3607 *
3608 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3609 *
3610 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3611 *
3612 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3613 *	queues before entering power save.
3614 *
3615 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3616 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3617 *	The callback can sleep.
3618 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3619 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3620 *	The callback must be atomic.
3621 *
3622 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3623 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3624 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3625 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3626 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3627 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3628 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3629 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3630 *	more-data bit must always be set.
3631 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3632 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3633 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3634 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3635 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3636 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3637 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3638 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3639 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3640 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3641 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3642 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3643 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3644 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3645 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3646 *	This callback must be atomic.
3647 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3648 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3649 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3650 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3651 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3652 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3653 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3654 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3655 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3656 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3657 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3658 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3659 *	This callback must be atomic.
3660 *
3661 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3662 *
3663 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3664 *
3665 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3666 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3667 *
3668 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3669 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3670 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3671 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3672 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3673 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3674 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3675 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3676 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3677 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3678 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3679 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3680 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3681 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3682 *      If duration is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the driver the
3683 *      duration for which the operation is requested.
3684 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3685 *
3686 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3687 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3688 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3689 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3690 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3691 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3692 *	2 * (DTIM period).
3693 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
3694 *
3695 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3696 *	This callback may sleep.
3697 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3698 *	This callback may sleep.
3699 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3700 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3701 *	channel context with different settings
3702 *	This callback may sleep.
3703 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3704 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3705 *	This callback may sleep.
3706 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3707 *	unbound from vif.
3708 *	This callback may sleep.
3709 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3710 *	another, as specified in the list of
3711 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3712 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3713 *	This callback may sleep.
3714 *
3715 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3716 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3717 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3718 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3719 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3720 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3721 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3722 *
3723 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3724 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3725 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3726 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3727 *	This callback may sleep.
3728 *
3729 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3730 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3731 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3732 *
3733 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3734 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3735 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3736 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3737 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3738 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3739 *	1 using ieee80211_csa_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3740 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3741 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3742 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3743 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3744 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3745 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3746 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3747 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3748 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3749 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3750 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3751 *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
3752 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3753 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
3754 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
3755 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
3756 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3757 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3758 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
3759 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3760 *
3761 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3762 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3763 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3764 *
3765 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3766 *	and hardware limits.
3767 *
3768 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3769 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3770 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3771 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3772 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3773 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3774 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3775 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3776 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3777 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3778 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3779 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3780 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3781 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
3782 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3783 *	the function call.
3784 *
3785 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3786 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3787 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3788 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3789 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3790 *
3791 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3792 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3793 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3794 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3795 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3796 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3797 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3798 *	changed parameters.
3799 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3800 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3801 *	this call.
3802 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3803 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3804 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
3805 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
3806 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
3807 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
3808 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
3809 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3810 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3811 *
3812 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
3813 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
3814 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
3815 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
3816 *	This callback may sleep.
3817 */
3818struct ieee80211_ops {
3819	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3820		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3821		   struct sk_buff *skb);
3822	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3823	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3824#ifdef CONFIG_PM
3825	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3826	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3827	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3828#endif
3829	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3830			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3831	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3832				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3833				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3834	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3835				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3836	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3837	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3838				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3839				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3840				 u32 changed);
3841
3842	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3843	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
3844
3845	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3846				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3847	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3848				 unsigned int changed_flags,
3849				 unsigned int *total_flags,
3850				 u64 multicast);
3851	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3852				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3853				    unsigned int filter_flags,
3854				    unsigned int changed_flags);
3855	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3856		       bool set);
3857	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3858		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3859		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3860	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3861				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3862				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3863				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3864				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
3865	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3866			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3867			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3868	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3869					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
3870	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3871		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
3872	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3873			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3874	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3875				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3876				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
3877				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
3878	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3879			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3880	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3881			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3882			      const u8 *mac_addr);
3883	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3884				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3885	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3886			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
3887	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3888			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3889			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
3890	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3891	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3892	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3893		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3894	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3895			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3896#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
3897	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3898				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3899				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3900				struct dentry *dir);
3901#endif
3902	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3903			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3904	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3905			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3906			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3907	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3908			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3909			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
3910			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
3911	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3912				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3913				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3914	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3915			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3916			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3917			      u32 changed);
3918	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3919				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3920				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3921	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3922			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3923			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3924			       struct station_info *sinfo);
3925	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3926		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
3927		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
3928	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3929	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3930			u64 tsf);
3931	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3932			   s64 offset);
3933	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3934	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3935
3936	/**
3937	 * @ampdu_action:
3938	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
3939	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
3940	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
3941	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3942	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
3943	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
3944	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
3945	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
3946	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
3947	 *
3948	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
3949	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
3950	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
3951	 *
3952	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
3953	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
3954	 *
3955	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
3956	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
3957	 * - ``TX:        81``
3958	 *
3959	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
3960	 *
3961	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
3962	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
3963	 * if the session can start immediately.
3964	 *
3965	 * The callback can sleep.
3966	 */
3967	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3968			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3969			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
 
 
3970	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
3971		struct survey_info *survey);
3972	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3973	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
3974#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
3975	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3976			    void *data, int len);
3977	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
3978			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
3979			     void *data, int len);
3980#endif
3981	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3982		      u32 queues, bool drop);
3983	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3984			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3985			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
 
3986	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
3987	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
3988
3989	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3990				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3991				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
3992				 int duration,
3993				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
3994	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3995					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
3996	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
3997	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3998			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
3999	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4000	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4001				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4002	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4003			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4004			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4005
4006	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4007				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4008				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4009				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4010				      bool more_data);
4011	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4012					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4013					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4014					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4015					bool more_data);
4016
4017	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4018				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4019	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4020				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4021				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4022	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4023				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4024				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4025
4026	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4027				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4028				  u16 duration);
4029
4030	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4031					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4032
4033	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4034			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4035	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4036			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4037	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4038			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4039			       u32 changed);
4040	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4041				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4042				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4043	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4044				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4045				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4046	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4047				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4048				  int n_vifs,
4049				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4050
4051	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4052				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4053
4054#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4055	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4056				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4057				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4058#endif
4059	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4060				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4061				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4062	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4063				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4064				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4065
4066	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4067				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4068	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4069				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4070	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4071					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4072					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4073
4074	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4075	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4076	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4077				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4078	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4079			   int *dbm);
4080
4081	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4082				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4083				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4084				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4085				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4086	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4087					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4088					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4089	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4090					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4091					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4092
4093	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4094			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4095	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4096
4097	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4098			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4099			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4100	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4101			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4102	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4103			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4104			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4105	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4106			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4107			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4108	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4109			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4110			    u8 instance_id);
4111	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4112				       struct sk_buff *head,
4113				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4114	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4115				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4116				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4117	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4118			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4119	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4120			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4121	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4122			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4123			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4124			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4125	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4126				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4127				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4128};
4129
4130/**
4131 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4132 *
4133 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4134 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4135 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4136 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4137 * @priv_data_len.
4138 *
4139 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4140 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4141 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4142 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4143 *
4144 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4145 */
4146struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4147					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4148					   const char *requested_name);
4149
4150/**
4151 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4152 *
4153 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4154 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4155 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4156 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4157 * @priv_data_len.
4158 *
4159 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4160 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4161 *
4162 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4163 */
4164static inline
4165struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4166					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4167{
4168	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4169}
4170
4171/**
4172 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4173 *
4174 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4175 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4176 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4177 *
4178 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4179 *
4180 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4181 */
4182int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4183
4184/**
4185 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4186 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4187 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4188 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4189 */
4190struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4191	int throughput;
4192	int blink_time;
4193};
4194
4195/**
4196 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4197 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4198 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4199 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4200 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4201 */
4202enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4203	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4204	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4205	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4206};
4207
4208#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4209const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4210const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4211const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4212const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4213const char *
4214__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4215				   unsigned int flags,
4216				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4217				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4218#endif
4219/**
4220 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4221 *
4222 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4223 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4224 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4225 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4226 *
4227 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4228 *
4229 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4230 */
4231static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4232{
4233#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4234	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4235#else
4236	return NULL;
4237#endif
4238}
4239
4240/**
4241 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4242 *
4243 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4244 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4245 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4246 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4247 *
4248 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4249 *
4250 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4251 */
4252static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4253{
4254#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4255	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4256#else
4257	return NULL;
4258#endif
4259}
4260
4261/**
4262 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4263 *
4264 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4265 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4266 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4267 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4268 *
4269 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4270 *
4271 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4272 */
4273static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4274{
4275#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4276	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4277#else
4278	return NULL;
4279#endif
4280}
4281
4282/**
4283 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4284 *
4285 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4286 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4287 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4288 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4289 *
4290 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4291 *
4292 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4293 */
4294static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4295{
4296#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4297	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4298#else
4299	return NULL;
4300#endif
4301}
4302
4303/**
4304 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4305 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4306 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4307 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4308 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4309 *
4310 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4311 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4312 *
4313 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4314 */
4315static inline const char *
4316ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4317				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4318				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4319{
4320#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4321	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4322						  blink_table_len);
4323#else
4324	return NULL;
4325#endif
4326}
4327
4328/**
4329 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4330 *
4331 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4332 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4333 *
4334 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4335 */
4336void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4337
4338/**
4339 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4340 *
4341 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4342 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4343 * before calling this function.
4344 *
4345 * @hw: the hardware to free
4346 */
4347void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4348
4349/**
4350 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4351 *
4352 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4353 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4354 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4355 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4356 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4357 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4358 *
4359 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4360 */
4361void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4362
4363/**
4364 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4365 *
4366 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4367 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4368 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4369 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4370 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4371 *
4372 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4373 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4374 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4375 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4376 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4377 *
4378 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4379 *
4380 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4381 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4382 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4383 * @list: the destination list
4384 */
4385void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4386		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4387
4388/**
4389 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4390 *
4391 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4392 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4393 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4394 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4395 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4396 *
4397 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4398 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4399 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4400 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4401 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4402 *
4403 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4404 *
4405 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4406 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4407 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4408 * @napi: the NAPI context
4409 */
4410void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4411		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4412
4413/**
4414 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4415 *
4416 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4417 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4418 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4419 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4420 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4421 *
4422 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4423 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4424 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4425 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4426 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4427 *
4428 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4429 *
4430 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4431 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4432 */
4433static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4434{
4435	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4436}
4437
4438/**
4439 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4440 *
4441 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4442 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4443 *
4444 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4445 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4446 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4447 *
4448 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4449 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4450 */
4451void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4452
4453/**
4454 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4455 *
4456 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4457 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4458 *
4459 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4460 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4461 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4462 *
4463 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4464 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4465 */
4466static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4467				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4468{
4469	local_bh_disable();
4470	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4471	local_bh_enable();
4472}
4473
4474/**
4475 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4476 *
4477 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4478 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4479 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4480 *
4481 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4482 *
4483 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4484 * each other.
4485 *
 
 
4486 * @sta: currently connected sta
4487 * @start: start or stop PS
4488 *
4489 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4490 */
4491int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4492
4493/**
4494 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4495 *                                  (in process context)
4496 *
4497 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4498 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4499 * applies.
4500 *
4501 * @sta: currently connected sta
4502 * @start: start or stop PS
4503 *
4504 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4505 */
4506static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4507						  bool start)
4508{
4509	int ret;
4510
4511	local_bh_disable();
4512	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4513	local_bh_enable();
4514
4515	return ret;
4516}
4517
4518/**
4519 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4520 * @sta: currently connected station
4521 *
4522 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4523 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4524 * connected station was received.
4525 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4526 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4527 * be serialized.
4528 */
4529void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4530
4531/**
4532 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4533 * @sta: currently connected station
4534 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4535 *
4536 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4537 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4538 * from a connected station was received.
4539 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4540 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4541 * serialized.
4542 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4543 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4544 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4545 * checks.
4546 */
4547void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4548
4549/*
4550 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4551 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4552 */
4553#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4554
4555/**
4556 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4557 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4558 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4559 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4560 *
4561 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4562 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4563 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4564 *
4565 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4566 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4567 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4568 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4569 *
4570 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4571 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4572 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4573 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4574 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4575 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4576 *
4577 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4578 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4579 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4580 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4581 * use this API.
4582 */
4583void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4584				u8 tid, bool buffered);
4585
4586/**
4587 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4588 *
4589 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4590 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4591 * rate selection table for the station entry.
4592 *
4593 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4594 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4595 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4596 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4597 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4598 */
4599void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4601			    struct sk_buff *skb,
4602			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4603			    int max_rates);
4604
4605/**
4606 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4607 *
4608 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4609 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4610 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4611 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4612 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4613 * slow stations to starve).
4614 *
4615 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4616 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4617 */
4618void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4619					   u32 thr);
4620
4621/**
4622 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
4623 *
4624 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
4625 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
4626 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
4627 *
4628 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4629 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
4630 * @info: tx status information
4631 */
4632void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4633			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4634			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
4635
4636/**
4637 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4638 *
4639 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4640 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4641 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4642 *
4643 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4644 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4645 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4646 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4647 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4648 *
4649 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4650 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4651 */
4652void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4653			 struct sk_buff *skb);
4654
4655/**
4656 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4657 *
4658 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4659 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4660 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4661 *
4662 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4663 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4664 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4665 *
4666 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4667 * @status: tx status information
4668 */
4669void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4670			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4671
4672/**
4673 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4674 *
4675 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4676 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4677 * specific skbs.
4678 *
4679 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4680 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4681 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4682 *
4683 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4684 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4685 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
4686 * @info: tx status information
4687 */
4688static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4689					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4690					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4691{
4692	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4693		.sta = sta,
4694		.info = info,
4695	};
4696
4697	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4698}
4699
4700/**
4701 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4702 *
4703 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4704 *
4705 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4706 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4707 * for a single hardware.
4708 *
4709 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4710 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4711 */
4712static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4713					  struct sk_buff *skb)
4714{
4715	local_bh_disable();
4716	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4717	local_bh_enable();
4718}
4719
4720/**
4721 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4722 *
4723 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4724 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4725 *
4726 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4727 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4728 *
4729 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4730 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4731 */
4732void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4733				 struct sk_buff *skb);
4734
4735/**
4736 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
4737 *
4738 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
4739 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
4740 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
4741 * 802.11 frames.
4742 *
4743 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4744 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
4745 * calls in the same tx status family.
4746 *
4747 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4748 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
4749 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4750 */
4751void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753			       struct sk_buff *skb);
4754
4755/**
4756 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4757 *
4758 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4759 * connected STA.
4760 *
4761 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4762 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4763 */
4764void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4765
4766#define IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4767
4768/**
4769 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4770 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4771 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4772 * @csa_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4773 *	to CSA counters.  This array can contain zero values which
4774 *	should be ignored.
4775 */
4776struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4777	u16 tim_offset;
4778	u16 tim_length;
4779
4780	u16 csa_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM];
4781};
4782
4783/**
4784 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4785 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4786 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4787 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4788 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
4789 *
4790 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4791 * obtain the beacon template.
4792 *
4793 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4794 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4795 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4796 * applicable, the CSA count.
4797 *
4798 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4799 *
4800 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4801 */
4802struct sk_buff *
4803ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4804			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4805			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
4806
4807/**
4808 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4809 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4810 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4811 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4812 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4813 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4814 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
4815 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4816 *
4817 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4818 * obtain the beacon frame.
4819 *
4820 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4821 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4822 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4823 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
 
 
 
 
4824 *
4825 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4826 *
4827 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4828 */
4829struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4830					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4831					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
4832
4833/**
4834 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4835 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4836 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4837 *
4838 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4839 *
4840 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4841 */
4842static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4843						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
4844{
4845	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
4846}
4847
4848/**
4849 * ieee80211_csa_update_counter - request mac80211 to decrement the csa counter
4850 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4851 *
4852 * The csa counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
4853 * This function is called implicitly when
4854 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
4855 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
4856 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's csa counters.
4857 *
4858 * Return: new csa counter value
4859 */
4860u8 ieee80211_csa_update_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4861
4862/**
4863 * ieee80211_csa_set_counter - request mac80211 to set csa counter
4864 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4865 * @counter: the new value for the counter
4866 *
4867 * The csa counter can be changed by the device, this API should be
4868 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
4869 *
4870 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_csa_update_counter(),
4871 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
4872 */
4873void ieee80211_csa_set_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
4874
4875/**
4876 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
4877 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4878 *
4879 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
4880 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
4881 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
4882 */
4883void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4884
4885/**
4886 * ieee80211_csa_is_complete - find out if counters reached 1
4887 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4888 *
4889 * This function returns whether the channel switch counters reached zero.
4890 */
4891bool ieee80211_csa_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4892
4893
4894/**
4895 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
4896 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4897 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4898 *
4899 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4900 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
4901 *
4902 * Can only be called in AP mode.
4903 *
4904 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
4905 */
4906struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4907					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4908
4909/**
4910 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
4911 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4912 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4913 *
4914 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
4915 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4916 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
4917 *
4918 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4919 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
4920 *
4921 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
4922 */
4923struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4924				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4925
4926/**
4927 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
4928 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4929 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4930 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
4931 *	if at all possible
4932 *
4933 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
4934 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4935 * BSSID and address is used.
4936 *
4937 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
4938 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
4939 *
4940 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4941 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
4942 *
4943 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
4944 */
4945struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4946				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4947				       bool qos_ok);
4948
4949/**
4950 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
4951 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4952 * @src_addr: source MAC address
4953 * @ssid: SSID buffer
4954 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
4955 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
 
4956 *
4957 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4958 * hardware.
4959 *
4960 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
4961 */
4962struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4963				       const u8 *src_addr,
4964				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
4965				       size_t tailroom);
4966
4967/**
4968 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
4969 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4970 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4971 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4972 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4973 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4974 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
4975 *
4976 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4977 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4978 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4979 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
4980 */
4981void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4982		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4983		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4984		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
4985
4986/**
4987 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
4988 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4989 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4990 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4991 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4992 *
4993 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4994 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4995 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4996 *
4997 * Return: The duration.
4998 */
4999__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5000			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5001			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5002
5003/**
5004 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5005 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5006 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5007 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5008 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5009 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5010 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5011 *
5012 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5013 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5014 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5015 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5016 */
5017void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5018			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5019			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5020			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5021			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5022
5023/**
5024 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5025 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5026 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5027 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5028 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5029 *
5030 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5031 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5032 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5033 *
5034 * Return: The duration.
5035 */
5036__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5037				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5038				    size_t frame_len,
5039				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5040
5041/**
5042 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5043 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5044 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5045 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5046 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5047 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5048 *
5049 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5050 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5051 *
5052 * Return: The duration.
5053 */
5054__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5055					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5056					enum nl80211_band band,
5057					size_t frame_len,
5058					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5059
5060/**
5061 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5062 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5063 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5064 *
5065 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5066 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5067 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5068 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5069 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5070 *
5071 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5072 * frames are available.
5073 *
5074 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5075 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5076 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5077 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5078 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5079 * use common code for all beacons.
5080 */
5081struct sk_buff *
5082ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5083
5084/**
5085 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5086 *
5087 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5088 *
5089 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5090 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5091 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5092 */
5093void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5094			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5095
5096/**
5097 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5098 *
5099 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5100 * from the given packet.
5101 *
5102 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5103 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5104 *	with this P1K
5105 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5106 */
5107static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5108					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5109{
5110	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5111	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5112	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5113
5114	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5115}
5116
5117/**
5118 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5119 *
5120 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5121 * and transmitter address.
5122 *
5123 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5124 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5125 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5126 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5127 */
5128void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5129			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5130
5131/**
5132 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5133 *
5134 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5135 * in the packet.
5136 *
5137 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5138 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5139 *	encrypted with this key
5140 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5141 */
5142void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5143			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5144
5145/**
5146 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5147 *
5148 * @pos: start of crypto header
5149 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5150 * @pn: PN to add
5151 *
5152 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5153 * the packet payload)
5154 *
5155 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5156 * point to the crypto header)
 
 
 
 
 
5157 */
5158u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
 
5159
5160/**
5161 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5162 *
5163 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5164 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5165 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5166 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5167 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5168 *
5169 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5170 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5171 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5172 *
5173 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5174 * can be done concurrently.
5175 */
5176void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5177			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5178
5179/**
5180 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5181 *
5182 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5183 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5184 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5185 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5186 * @seq: new sequence data
5187 *
5188 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5189 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5190 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5191 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5192 *
5193 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5194 * can be done concurrently.
5195 */
5196void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5197			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5198
5199/**
5200 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5201 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5202 *
5203 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5204 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5205 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5206 *
5207 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5208 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5209 */
5210void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5211
5212/**
5213 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5214 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5215 * @keyconf: new key data
5216 *
5217 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5218 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5219 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5220 *
5221 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5222 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5223 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5224 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5225 *
5226 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5227 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5228 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5229 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5230 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5231 * of the reconfiguration.
5232 *
5233 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5234 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5235 *
5236 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5237 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5238 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5239 * the key that's being replaced.
5240 */
5241struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5242ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5243			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5244
5245/**
5246 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5247 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5248 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5249 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5250 * @gfp: allocation flags
5251 */
5252void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5253				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5254
5255/**
5256 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5257 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5258 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5259 *
5260 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5261 */
5262void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5263
5264/**
5265 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5266 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5267 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5268 *
5269 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5270 */
5271void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5272
5273/**
5274 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5275 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5276 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5277 *
5278 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5279 *
5280 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5281 */
5282
5283int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5284
5285/**
5286 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5287 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5288 *
5289 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5290 */
5291void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5292
5293/**
5294 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5295 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5296 *
5297 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5298 */
5299void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5300
5301/**
5302 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5303 *
5304 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5305 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5306 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5307 * any context, including hardirq context.
5308 *
5309 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5310 * @info: information about the completed scan
5311 */
5312void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5313			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5314
5315/**
5316 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5317 *
5318 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5319 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5320 *
5321 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5322 */
5323void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5324
5325/**
5326 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5327 *
5328 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5329 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5330 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5331 * while associating, for instance.
5332 *
5333 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5334 */
5335void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5336
5337/**
5338 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5339 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5340 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5341 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5342 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5343 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5344 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5345 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5346 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5347 */
5348enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5349	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5350	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5351	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5352};
5353
5354/**
5355 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5356 *
5357 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5358 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5359 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5360 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5361 *
5362 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5363 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5364 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5365 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5366 */
5367void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5368				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5369						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5370				  void *data);
5371
5372/**
5373 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5374 *
5375 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5376 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5377 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5378 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5379 * be used.
5380 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5381 *
5382 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5383 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5384 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5385 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5386 */
5387static inline void
5388ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5389				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5390						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5391				    void *data)
5392{
5393	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5394				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5395				     iterator, data);
5396}
5397
5398/**
5399 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5400 *
5401 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5402 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5403 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5404 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5405 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5406 *
5407 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5408 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5409 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5410 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5411 */
5412void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5413						u32 iter_flags,
5414						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5415						    u8 *mac,
5416						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5417						void *data);
5418
5419/**
5420 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl - iterate active interfaces
5421 *
5422 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5423 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5424 * This version can only be used while holding the RTNL.
5425 *
5426 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5427 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5428 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5429 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5430 */
5431void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5432					      u32 iter_flags,
5433					      void (*iterator)(void *data,
5434						u8 *mac,
5435						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5436					      void *data);
5437
5438/**
5439 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5440 *
5441 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5442 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5443 * function for them.
5444 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5445 *
5446 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5447 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5448 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5449 */
5450void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5451				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5452						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5453				       void *data);
5454/**
5455 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5456 *
5457 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5458 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5459 *
5460 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5461 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5462 */
5463void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5464
5465/**
5466 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5467 *
5468 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5469 * workqueue.
5470 *
5471 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5472 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5473 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5474 */
5475void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5476				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5477				  unsigned long delay);
5478
5479/**
5480 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5481 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5482 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5483 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5484 *
5485 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5486 *
5487 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5488 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5489 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5490 */
5491int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5492				  u16 timeout);
5493
5494/**
5495 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5496 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5497 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5498 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5499 *
5500 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5501 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5502 * from any context.
5503 */
5504void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5505				      u16 tid);
5506
5507/**
5508 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5509 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5510 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5511 *
5512 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5513 *
5514 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5515 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5516 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5517 */
5518int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5519
5520/**
5521 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5522 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5523 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5524 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5525 *
5526 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5527 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5528 * can be called from any context.
5529 */
5530void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5531				     u16 tid);
5532
5533/**
5534 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5535 *
5536 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5537 * @addr: station's address
5538 *
5539 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5540 *
5541 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5542 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5543 */
5544struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5545					 const u8 *addr);
5546
5547/**
5548 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5549 *
5550 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5551 * @addr: remote station's address
5552 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5553 *
5554 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5555 *
5556 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5557 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5558 *
5559 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5560 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5561 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5562 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5563 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5564 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5565 *      is not reliable.
5566 *
5567 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5568 */
5569struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5570					       const u8 *addr,
5571					       const u8 *localaddr);
5572
5573/**
5574 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5575 * @hw: the hardware
5576 * @pubsta: the station
5577 * @block: whether to block or unblock
5578 *
5579 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5580 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5581 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5582 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5583 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5584 *
5585 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5586 * manner.
5587 *
5588 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5589 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5590 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5591 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5592 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5593 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5594 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5595 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5596 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5597 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5598 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5599 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5600 * woke up while blocked or not.
5601 */
5602void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5603			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5604
5605/**
5606 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5607 * @pubsta: the station
5608 *
5609 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5610 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5611 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5612 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5613 *
5614 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5615 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5616 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5617 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5618 *
5619 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5620 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5621 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5622 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
5623 */
5624void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5625
5626/**
5627 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5628 * @pubsta: the station
5629 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5630 *
5631 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5632 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5633 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5634 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5635 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5636 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5637 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5638 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5639 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5640 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5641 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5642 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5643 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5644 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5645 */
5646void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5647
5648/**
5649 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
5650 *
5651 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver can call
5652 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
5653 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
5654 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
5655 *
5656 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
5657 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
5658 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
5659 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
5660 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
5661 * attempts.
5662 *
5663 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
5664 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
5665 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
5666 * them to 0.
5667 *
5668 * @pubsta: the station
5669 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
5670 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
5671 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
5672 */
5673void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5674				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
5675
5676/**
5677 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
5678 *
5679 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5680 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5681 *
5682 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
5683 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
5684 */
5685bool
5686ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5687
5688/**
5689 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5690 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5691 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5692 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5693 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5694 *
5695 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5696 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5697 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5698 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5699 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5700 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5701 *
5702 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5703 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5704 * set_key callback.
5705 */
5706void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5707			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5708			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5709				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5710				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5711				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5712				      void *data),
5713			 void *iter_data);
5714
5715/**
5716 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5717 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5718 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5719 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5720 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5721 *
5722 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5723 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5724 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5725 * in removal process will be skipped.
5726 *
5727 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5728 * and thus iter must be atomic.
5729 */
5730void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5731			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5732			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5733					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5734					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5735					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5736					  void *data),
5737			     void *iter_data);
5738
5739/**
5740 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5741 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5742 * @iter: iterator function
5743 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5744 *
5745 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5746 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5747 * places while calling into the driver.
5748 *
5749 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5750 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5751 * removed.
5752 *
5753 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5754 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5755 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5756 * or not.
5757 */
5758void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5759	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5760	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5761		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5762		     void *data),
5763	void *iter_data);
5764
5765/**
5766 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5767 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5768 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5769 *
5770 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5771 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5772 * information. This function must only be called from within the
5773 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5774 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5775 * %NULL.
5776 *
5777 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5778 */
5779struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5780					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5781
5782/**
5783 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5784 *
5785 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5786 *
5787 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
5788 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
5789 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
5790 */
5791void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5792
5793/**
5794 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
5795 *
5796 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5797 *
5798 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
5799 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
5800 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
5801 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
5802 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
5803 *
5804 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
5805 * without connection recovery attempts.
5806 */
5807void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5808
5809/**
5810 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
5811 *
5812 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5813 *
5814 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
5815 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
5816 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
5817 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
5818 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
5819 *
5820 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
5821 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
5822 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
5823 * disconnect normally later.
5824 *
5825 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
5826 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
5827 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
5828 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
5829 */
5830void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5831
5832/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5833 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
5834 *	rssi threshold triggered
5835 *
5836 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5837 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
5838 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
5839 * @gfp: context flags
5840 *
5841 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
5842 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
5843 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
5844 */
5845void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5846			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
5847			       s32 rssi_level,
5848			       gfp_t gfp);
5849
5850/**
5851 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
5852 *
5853 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5854 * @gfp: context flags
5855 */
5856void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
5857
5858/**
5859 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
5860 *
5861 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 
5862 */
5863void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5864
5865/**
5866 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
5867 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5868 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
5869 *
5870 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
5871 * and wake up the suspended queues.
5872 */
5873void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
5874
5875/**
5876 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
5877 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5878 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
5879 *
5880 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
5881 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
5882 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
5883 */
5884void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5885			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
5886
5887/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5888 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
5889 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5890 */
5891void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5892
5893/**
5894 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
5895 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5896 */
5897void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5898
5899/**
5900 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
5901 *
5902 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
5903 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
5904 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
5905 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
5906 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
5907 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
5908 *
5909 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5910 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
5911 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
5912 */
5913void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
5914				  const u8 *addr);
5915
5916/**
5917 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
5918 * @pubsta: station struct
5919 * @tid: the session's TID
5920 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
5921 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
5922 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
5923 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
5924 *
5925 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
5926 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
5927 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
5928 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
5929 */
5930void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5931					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
5932					  u16 received_mpdus);
5933
5934/**
5935 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
5936 *
5937 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
5938 * buffer.
5939 *
5940 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5941 * @ra: the peer's destination address
5942 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
5943 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
5944 */
5945void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
5946
5947/**
5948 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
5949 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5950 * @addr: station mac address
5951 * @tid: the rx tid
5952 */
5953void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
5954				 unsigned int tid);
5955
5956/**
5957 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
5958 *
5959 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5960 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5961 * reordering.
5962 *
5963 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5964 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
5965 *
5966 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5967 * @addr: station mac address
5968 * @tid: the rx tid
5969 */
5970static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5971						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5972{
5973	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5974		return;
5975	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
5976}
5977
5978/**
5979 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
5980 *
5981 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5982 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5983 * reordering.
5984 *
5985 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5986 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
5987 *
5988 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5989 * @addr: station mac address
5990 * @tid: the rx tid
5991 */
5992static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5993						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5994{
5995	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5996		return;
5997	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
5998}
5999
6000/**
6001 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6002 *
6003 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6004 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6005 *
6006 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6007 *
6008 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6009 * @addr: station mac address
6010 * @tid: the rx tid
6011 */
6012void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6013				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6014
6015/* Rate control API */
6016
6017/**
6018 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6019 *
6020 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6021 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6022 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6023 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6024 *	to be filled in
6025 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6026 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6027 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6028 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6029 *	RTS threshold
6030 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6031 *	if the selected rate supports it
6032 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6033 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
 
 
 
 
6034 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6035 */
6036struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6037	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6038	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6039	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6040	struct sk_buff *skb;
6041	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6042	bool rts, short_preamble;
 
6043	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6044	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6045	bool bss;
6046};
6047
6048/**
6049 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6050 */
6051enum rate_control_capabilities {
6052	/**
6053	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6054	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6055	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6056	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6057	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6058	 */
6059	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6060};
6061
6062struct rate_control_ops {
6063	unsigned long capa;
6064	const char *name;
6065	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6066	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6067			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6068	void (*free)(void *priv);
6069
6070	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6071	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6072			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6073			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6074	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6075			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6076			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6077			    u32 changed);
6078	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6079			 void *priv_sta);
6080
6081	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6082			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6083			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6084	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6085			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6086			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6087	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6088			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6089
6090	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6091				struct dentry *dir);
6092
6093	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6094};
6095
6096static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6097				 enum nl80211_band band,
6098				 int index)
6099{
6100	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6101}
6102
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6103static inline s8
6104rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6105		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6106{
6107	int i;
6108
6109	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6110		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6111			return i;
6112
6113	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6114	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6115
6116	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6117	return 0;
6118}
6119
6120static inline
6121bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6122			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6123{
6124	unsigned int i;
6125
6126	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6127		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6128			return true;
6129	return false;
6130}
6131
6132/**
6133 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6134 *
6135 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6136 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6137 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6138 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6139 *
6140 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6141 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6142 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6143 */
6144int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6145			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6146			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6147
6148int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6149void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6150
6151static inline bool
6152conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6153{
6154	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6155}
6156
6157static inline bool
6158conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6159{
6160	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6161	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6162}
6163
6164static inline bool
6165conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6166{
6167	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6168	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6169}
6170
6171static inline bool
6172conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6173{
6174	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6175}
6176
6177static inline bool
6178conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6179{
6180	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6181		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6182		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6183}
6184
6185static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6186ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6187{
6188	if (p2p) {
6189		switch (type) {
6190		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6191			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6192		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6193			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6194		default:
6195			break;
6196		}
6197	}
6198	return type;
6199}
6200
6201static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6202ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6203{
6204	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6205}
6206
6207/**
6208 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6209 *
6210 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6211 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6212 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6213 *
6214 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6215 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6216 * matching GroupId management frame.
6217 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6218 */
6219void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6220				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6221
6222void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6223				   int rssi_min_thold,
6224				   int rssi_max_thold);
6225
6226void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6227
6228/**
6229 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6230 *
6231 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6232 *
6233 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6234 *
6235 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6236 * applicable.
6237 */
6238int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6239
6240/**
6241 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6242 * @vif: virtual interface
6243 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6244 * @gfp: allocation flags
6245 *
6246 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6247 */
6248void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6249				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6250				    gfp_t gfp);
6251
6252/**
6253 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6254 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6255 * @vif: virtual interface
6256 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6257 * @band: the band to transmit on
6258 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6259 *
6260 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6261 */
6262bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6263			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6264			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6265
6266/**
6267 * Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header of injected frames
6268 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6269 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6270 */
6271bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6272				 struct net_device *dev);
6273
6274/**
6275 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6276 *
6277 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6278 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6279 *
6280 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6281 *
6282 * private:
6283 *
6284 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6285 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6286 */
6287struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6288	u32 next_tsf;
6289	bool has_next_tsf;
6290
6291	u8 absent;
6292
6293	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6294	struct {
6295		u32 start;
6296		u32 duration;
6297		u32 interval;
6298	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6299};
6300
6301/**
6302 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6303 *
6304 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6305 * @data: NoA tracking data
6306 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6307 *
6308 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6309 */
6310int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6311			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6312
6313/**
6314 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6315 *
6316 * @data: NoA tracking data
6317 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6318 */
6319void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6320
6321/**
6322 * ieee80211_tdls_oper - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6323 * @vif: virtual interface
6324 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6325 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6326 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6327 * @gfp: allocation flags
6328 *
6329 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6330 */
6331void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6332				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6333				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6334
6335/**
6336 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6337 *
6338 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6339 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6340 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6341 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6342 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6343 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6344 *
6345 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6346 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6347 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6348 *
6349 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6350 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6351 *
6352 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6353 */
6354int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6355
6356/**
6357 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6358 *
6359 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6360 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6361 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6362 *
6363 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6364 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6365 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6366 *
6367 * @sta: the station
6368 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6369 */
6370void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6371
6372/**
6373 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6374 *
6375 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6376 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6377 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6378 *
6379 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6380 *
6381 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6382 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6383 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6384 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6385 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6386 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6387 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6388 *
6389 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6390 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6391 */
6392struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6393				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6394
6395/**
6396 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6397 * (in process context)
6398 *
6399 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6400 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6401 *
6402 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6403 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6404 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6405 */
6406static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6407						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6408{
6409	struct sk_buff *skb;
6410
6411	local_bh_disable();
6412	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6413	local_bh_enable();
6414
6415	return skb;
6416}
6417
6418/**
6419 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6420 *
6421 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6422 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6423 *
6424 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6425 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6426 * driver has finished scheduling it.
6427 */
6428struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6429
6430/**
6431 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
6432 *
6433 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6434 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
6435 *
6436 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
6437 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
6438 */
6439void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6440
6441/* (deprecated) */
6442static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
6443{
6444}
6445
6446void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6447			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
6448
6449/**
6450 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
6451 *
6452 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6453 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6454 *
6455 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
6456 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
6457 *
6458 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
6459 * this TXQ internally.
6460 */
6461static inline void
6462ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6463{
6464	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
6465}
6466
6467/**
6468 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
6469 *
6470 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6471 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6472 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
6473 *
6474 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
6475 * internally.
6476 */
6477static inline void
6478ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6479		     bool force)
6480{
6481	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
6482}
6483
6484/**
6485 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
6486 *
6487 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
6488 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
6489 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
6490 * next_txq().
6491 *
6492 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
6493 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
6494 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
6495 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
6496 * again.
6497 *
6498 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
6499 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
6500 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
6501 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
6502 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
6503 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
6504 *
6505 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6506 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6507 */
6508bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6509				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6510
6511/**
6512 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
6513 *
6514 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
6515 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
6516 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
6517 *
6518 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6519 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
6520 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
6521 */
6522void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6523			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
6524			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
6525
6526/**
6527 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
6528 *
6529 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
6530 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6531 *
6532 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6533 * @inst_id: the local instance id
6534 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
6535 * @gfp: allocation flags
6536 */
6537void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6538				   u8 inst_id,
6539				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
6540				   gfp_t gfp);
6541
6542/**
6543 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
6544 *
6545 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
6546 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
6547 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6548 *
6549 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6550 * @match: match event information
6551 * @gfp: allocation flags
6552 */
6553void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6554			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
6555			      gfp_t gfp);
6556
6557/**
6558 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
6559 *
6560 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6561 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
6562 *
6563 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6564 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
6565 *          information.
6566 * @len: frame length in bytes
6567 */
6568u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6569			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
6570			      int len);
6571
6572/**
6573 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
6574 *
6575 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6576 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
6577 *
6578 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6579 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6580 * @len: frame length in bytes
6581 */
6582u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6583			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
6584			      int len);
6585/**
6586 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
6587 *
6588 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
6589 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
6590 * hardware or firmware.
6591 *
6592 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6593 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
6594 */
6595bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
6596
6597#endif /* MAC80211_H */